]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - ld/ld.texi
elf: Pass need_layout to _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
CommitLineData
252b5132
RH
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
a2c58332 3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 4@syncodeindex ky cp
dff70155 5@c man begin INCLUDE
252b5132
RH
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
c428fa83 8@include bfdver.texi
dff70155 9@c man end
252b5132
RH
10
11@c @smallbook
12
ff5dcc92
SC
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
0285c67d
NC
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
0285c67d 22@set ARM
ac145307 23@set C6X
b8891f8d 24@set CSKY
49fa1e15 25@set H8300
0285c67d 26@set HPPA
0285c67d 27@set M68HC11
7fb9f789 28@set M68K
833794fc 29@set MIPS
3c3bdf30 30@set MMIX
2469cfa2 31@set MSP430
35c08157 32@set NDS32
78058a5e 33@set NIOSII
fa1477dc 34@set PDP11
2a60a7a8
AM
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
49fa1e15 37@set Renesas
b4cbbe8f 38@set S/390
49fa1e15
AM
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
2ca22b03 41@set WIN32
e0001a05 42@set XTENSA
0285c67d
NC
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
9160ea82
AM
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
252b5132 49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
9160ea82
AM
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
252b5132 52
0e9517a9 53@copying
e49e529d
JM
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 59
a2c58332 60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 61
cf055d54 62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
cf055d54
NC
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0e9517a9 68@end copying
252b5132
RH
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
71ba23f6 72@settitle The GNU linker
252b5132 73@titlepage
71ba23f6 74@title The GNU linker
252b5132 75@sp 1
e49e529d
JM
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
252b5132
RH
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
252b5132
RH
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
704c465c
NC
87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88\hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
71ba23f6 89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
252b5132
RH
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
0285c67d 96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
a2c58332 97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 98
0285c67d 99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
0285c67d
NC
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0285c67d 105@c man end
252b5132 106
252b5132
RH
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
4ecceb71 109@contents
252b5132
RH
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
84ec0e6d 112@ifnottex
252b5132 113@node Top
71ba23f6 114@top LD
e49e529d
JM
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 120
cf055d54 121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
793c5807
NC
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
cf055d54 124
252b5132
RH
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
bf6d8037 129* Plugins:: Linker Plugins
252b5132
RH
130@ifset GENERIC
131* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132@end ifset
133@ifclear GENERIC
134@ifset H8300
135* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136@end ifset
c2dcd04e
NC
137@ifset Renesas
138* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
252b5132 139@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
140@ifset ARM
141* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
143@ifset M68HC11
144* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
146@ifset HPPA
147* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
149@ifset M68K
150* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151@end ifset
833794fc
MR
152@ifset MIPS
153* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
155@ifset POWERPC
156* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157@end ifset
158@ifset POWERPC64
159* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
161@ifset S/390
162* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
164@ifset SPU
165* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166@end ifset
74459f0e
TW
167@ifset TICOFF
168* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
170@ifset WIN32
171* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
173@ifset XTENSA
174* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175@end ifset
252b5132
RH
176@end ifclear
177@ifclear SingleFormat
178* BFD:: BFD
179@end ifclear
180@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
704c465c 184* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
370b66a1 185* LD Index:: LD Index
252b5132 186@end menu
84ec0e6d 187@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
188
189@node Overview
190@chapter Overview
191
192@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193@cindex what is this?
0285c67d 194
0879a67a 195@ifset man
0285c67d 196@c man begin SYNOPSIS
ff5dcc92 197ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
0285c67d
NC
198@c man end
199
200@c man begin SEEALSO
201ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203@file{ld}.
204@c man end
205@end ifset
206
207@c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
ff5dcc92 209@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
252b5132 210their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
ff5dcc92 211compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
252b5132 212
ff5dcc92 213@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
252b5132
RH
214a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
0285c67d
NC
217@ifset man
218@c For the man only
ece2d90e 219This man page does not describe the command language; see the
71ba23f6
NC
220@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
0285c67d
NC
222@end ifset
223
252b5132 224@ifclear SingleFormat
ff5dcc92
SC
225This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
252b5132
RH
227write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230@end ifclear
231
232Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
ff5dcc92 235@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
252b5132
RH
236(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
0285c67d
NC
238@c man end
239
252b5132
RH
240@node Invocation
241@chapter Invocation
242
0285c67d
NC
243@c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
ff5dcc92 245The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
252b5132
RH
246and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
0285c67d
NC
249@c man end
250
252b5132
RH
251@ifset UsesEnvVars
252@menu
a05a5b64 253* Options:: Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
254* Environment:: Environment Variables
255@end menu
256
257@node Options
a05a5b64 258@section Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
259@end ifset
260
261@cindex command line
262@cindex options
0285c67d
NC
263
264@c man begin OPTIONS
265
252b5132
RH
266The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268@cindex standard Unix system
ff5dcc92 269For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
252b5132
RH
270object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273@smallexample
274ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275@end smallexample
276
ff5dcc92 277This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
252b5132
RH
278result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
ff5dcc92 282Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
511ab9e9
ILT
283point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
252b5132
RH
288occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290noted in the descriptions below.
291
292@cindex object files
511ab9e9
ILT
293Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296an option and its argument.
252b5132
RH
297
298Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302message @samp{No input files}.
303
36f63dca 304If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
252b5132
RH
305assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
53d25da6
AM
310@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
252b5132
RH
315
316For options whose names are a single letter,
317option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319option that requires them.
320
321For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
e4897a32 322precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
36f63dca 323@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
e4897a32 324this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
ba1be17e 325only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
e4897a32
NC
326@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328output.
329
330Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335accepted.
252b5132 336
36f63dca 337Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
a05a5b64 338(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
fa19fce0
NC
339prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340compiler driver) like this:
4e53152f
NC
341
342@smallexample
2509a395 343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
4e53152f
NC
344@end smallexample
345
346This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
2509a395
SL
347silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354@smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356@end smallexample
4e53152f 357
a05a5b64 358Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
4e53152f
NC
359linker:
360
ff5dcc92 361@table @gcctabopt
38fc1cb1 362@include at-file.texi
dff70155 363
2509a395
SL
364@kindex -a @var{keyword}
365@item -a @var{keyword}
252b5132
RH
366This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
7ee314fa
AM
372@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
9d5777a3 379it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
7ee314fa 380This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
9d5777a3 381interface.
7ee314fa 382
252b5132
RH
383@ifclear SingleFormat
384@cindex binary input format
385@kindex -b @var{format}
386@kindex --format=@var{format}
387@cindex input format
388@cindex input format
389@item -b @var{input-format}
390@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
391@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 393@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
ff5dcc92 394that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
252b5132 395configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
ff5dcc92 396to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
252b5132
RH
397default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401@xref{BFD}.
402
403You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405linking object files of different formats), by including
406@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
a1ab1d2a 407particular format.
252b5132
RH
408
409The default format is taken from the environment variable
410@code{GNUTARGET}.
411@ifset UsesEnvVars
412@xref{Environment}.
413@end ifset
414You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
0285c67d
NC
415@code{TARGET};
416@ifclear man
417see @ref{Format Commands}.
418@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
419@end ifclear
420
421@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423@cindex compatibility, MRI
424@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
ff5dcc92 426For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
252b5132 427files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
0285c67d
NC
428@ifclear man
429@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430@end ifclear
431@ifset man
432the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433@end ifset
434Introduce MRI script files with
252b5132 435the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
ff5dcc92
SC
436scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
252b5132
RH
438specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440@cindex common allocation
441@kindex -d
442@kindex -dc
443@kindex -dp
a1ab1d2a 444@item -d
252b5132
RH
445@itemx -dc
446@itemx -dp
447These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
7ee314fa
AM
453@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
9d5777a3 462The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
7ee314fa 463
abf874aa
CL
464@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
466This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
467fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
468section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
469error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
470several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
471section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
472sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
473
474@smallexample
475 MEMORY @{
476 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
477 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
479 @}
480 SECTIONS @{
481 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
482 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
484 @}
485
486 with input sections:
487 .data.1: size 8
488 .data.2: size 0x10
489 .data.3: size 4
490
491 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
492 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
493@end smallexample
494
495This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
496the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
497
498@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
500This option enables warnings when
501@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
502matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
503discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
504output region.
505
252b5132
RH
506@cindex entry point, from command line
507@kindex -e @var{entry}
508@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
a1ab1d2a 509@item -e @var{entry}
252b5132
RH
510@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
511Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
512program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
513named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
514and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
515base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
516@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
517and other ways of specifying the entry point.
518
b58f81ae
DJ
519@kindex --exclude-libs
520@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
521Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
e1c37eb5 522exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
b58f81ae
DJ
523@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
524automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
525port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
526explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
527option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
528be treated as hidden.
529
e1c37eb5
DK
530@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
531@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
532Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
533should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
534into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
535may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
536used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
537the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
538match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
539command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
540of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
541regardless of this option.
542
252b5132
RH
543@cindex dynamic symbol table
544@kindex -E
545@kindex --export-dynamic
267e2722 546@kindex --no-export-dynamic
252b5132
RH
547@item -E
548@itemx --export-dynamic
267e2722
CD
549@itemx --no-export-dynamic
550When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
551option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
552all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
553set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
554
555If you do not use either of these options (or use the
556@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
557dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
558referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
252b5132
RH
559
560If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
561back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
562dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
563linking the program itself.
564
55255dae 565You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
cb840a31 566be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
55255dae 567See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
cb840a31 568
8b747e1a
DK
569Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
570support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
571the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
572
37a141bf
FS
573@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
574@cindex export dynamic symbol
575@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
576When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
577@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
578shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
579bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
580no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
581@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
582on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
583
584@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
585@cindex export dynamic symbol list
586@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
587Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
588The format of the file is the same as the version node without
589scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
590
36f63dca 591@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
592@cindex big-endian objects
593@cindex endianness
594@kindex -EB
595@item -EB
596Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
597
598@cindex little-endian objects
599@kindex -EL
600@item -EL
601Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
36f63dca 602@end ifclear
252b5132 603
2509a395
SL
604@kindex -f @var{name}
605@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
606@item -f @var{name}
607@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
608When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
609to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
610table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
611symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
612
613If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
614run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
615the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
616first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
617@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
618in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
619Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
620implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
a094d01f 621machine-specific performance.
252b5132
RH
622
623This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
624will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
625
2509a395
SL
626@kindex -F @var{name}
627@kindex --filter=@var{name}
252b5132 628@item -F @var{name}
2509a395 629@itemx --filter=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
630When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
631the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
632of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
633on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
634
635If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
636run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
637dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
638filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
639found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
640used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
641@var{name}.
642
ff5dcc92 643Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
252b5132 644toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
36f63dca
NC
645object files.
646@ifclear SingleFormat
647The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
ece2d90e 648@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
252b5132 649@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
36f63dca
NC
650environment variable.
651@end ifclear
652The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
653creating an ELF shared object.
252b5132 654
3dbf70a2 655@cindex finalization function
2509a395
SL
656@kindex -fini=@var{name}
657@item -fini=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
658When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
659executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
660address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
661the function to call.
662
252b5132
RH
663@kindex -g
664@item -g
665Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
666
2509a395
SL
667@kindex -G @var{value}
668@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
252b5132 669@cindex object size
2509a395 670@item -G @var{value}
252b5132
RH
671@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
672Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
673@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
e8044f35 674MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
252b5132
RH
675sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
676
677@cindex runtime library name
2509a395 678@kindex -h @var{name}
252b5132 679@kindex -soname=@var{name}
2509a395 680@item -h @var{name}
252b5132
RH
681@itemx -soname=@var{name}
682When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
683the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
684which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
685linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
010e444b 686field rather than using the file name given to the linker.
252b5132
RH
687
688@kindex -i
689@cindex incremental link
690@item -i
691Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
692
3dbf70a2 693@cindex initialization function
2509a395
SL
694@kindex -init=@var{name}
695@item -init=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
696When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
697executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
698of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
699function to call.
700
252b5132 701@cindex archive files, from cmd line
2509a395 702@kindex -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf 703@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
2509a395 704@item -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf
RS
705@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
706Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
707list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
708If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
07d8eb55 709will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
bcb674cf 710will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
252b5132 711
ff5dcc92 712On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
bcb674cf
RS
713files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
714and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
715called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
716@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
717indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
718to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
719@var{filename}.
252b5132
RH
720
721The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
722specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
723was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
724command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
725archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
726the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
727
ff5dcc92 728See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
252b5132
RH
729archives multiple times.
730
731You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
732
733@ifset GENERIC
734This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
ff5dcc92 735if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
252b5132
RH
736behaviour of the AIX linker.
737@end ifset
738
739@cindex search directory, from cmd line
2509a395 740@kindex -L @var{dir}
252b5132 741@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
2509a395 742@item -L @var{searchdir}
252b5132 743@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
ff5dcc92
SC
744Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
745for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
252b5132
RH
746option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
747in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
748on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
ff5dcc92 749@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
7d24f02c
KH
750order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
751how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
752option is specified.
252b5132 753
3aa2d05a
NC
754If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
755prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
756@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
9c8ebd6a 757
252b5132
RH
758@ifset UsesEnvVars
759The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
ff5dcc92 760@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
252b5132
RH
761some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
762@end ifset
763
764The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
765@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
766at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
767
768@cindex emulation
769@kindex -m @var{emulation}
2509a395 770@item -m @var{emulation}
252b5132
RH
771Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
772emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
773
774If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
775@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
776
777Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
778configured.
779
780@cindex link map
781@kindex -M
782@kindex --print-map
783@item -M
784@itemx --print-map
785Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
786information about the link, including the following:
787
788@itemize @bullet
789@item
3b83e13a 790Where object files are mapped into memory.
252b5132
RH
791@item
792How common symbols are allocated.
793@item
794All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
795which caused the archive member to be brought in.
3b83e13a
NC
796@item
797The values assigned to symbols.
798
799Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
800involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
801have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
802linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
803of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
804the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
805linker script containing:
806
807@smallexample
808 foo = 1
809 foo = foo * 4
810 foo = foo + 8
811@end smallexample
812
813will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
814option is used:
815
816@smallexample
817 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
819 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
820@end smallexample
821
822See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
823scripts.
d2ef37eb 824
06ddcada
AM
825@item
826How GNU properties are merged.
d2ef37eb 827
06ddcada
AM
828When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
829.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
830These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
d2ef37eb
L
831
832@smallexample
833Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
834@end smallexample
835
06ddcada 836This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
d2ef37eb
L
837merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
838is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
839
840@smallexample
06ddcada 841Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
d2ef37eb
L
842@end smallexample
843
06ddcada 844This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
d2ef37eb
L
845when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
846is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
252b5132
RH
847@end itemize
848
035801ce
FS
849@cindex link map discarded
850@kindex --print-map-discarded
851@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
852@item --print-map-discarded
853@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
854Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
855in the link map. Enabled by default.
856
252b5132
RH
857@kindex -n
858@cindex read-only text
859@cindex NMAGIC
860@kindex --nmagic
861@item -n
862@itemx --nmagic
90f5d9d9
JZ
863Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
864libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
865mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
252b5132
RH
866
867@kindex -N
868@kindex --omagic
869@cindex read/write from cmd line
870@cindex OMAGIC
a1ab1d2a 871@item -N
252b5132
RH
872@itemx --omagic
873Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
63fd3b82
NC
874not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
875libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
4d8907ac
DS
876mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
877is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
878specification published by Microsoft.
63fd3b82
NC
879
880@kindex --no-omagic
881@cindex OMAGIC
882@item --no-omagic
883This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
884sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
885be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
886shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
252b5132
RH
887
888@kindex -o @var{output}
889@kindex --output=@var{output}
890@cindex naming the output file
891@item -o @var{output}
892@itemx --output=@var{output}
ff5dcc92 893Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
252b5132
RH
894option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
895script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
896
f37b21b4
RM
897@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
898@cindex dependency file
899@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
900Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
901suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
902that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
903output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
904Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
905Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
906to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
907linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
908@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
909installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
910distributed makefiles without careful editing.
911
252b5132
RH
912@kindex -O @var{level}
913@cindex generating optimized output
914@item -O @var{level}
ff5dcc92 915If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
252b5132 916the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
98c503ac
NC
917should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
918option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
919the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
920no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
921of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
252b5132 922
387dd777
DP
923@kindex -plugin @var{name}
924@item -plugin @var{name}
925Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
926the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
927automatically added by the complier, when using link time
928optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
929wish.
930
931Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
932from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
933@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
934those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
41f37a6f 935copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
387dd777 936based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
6c19b93b 937just copy in the newest one.
387dd777 938
26278bb8
UD
939@kindex --push-state
940@cindex push state governing input file handling
941@item --push-state
f9a6a8f0 942The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
26278bb8
UD
943flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
944restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
945
946The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
947@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
948@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
949@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
950@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
951@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
952
953One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
954used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
955listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
956something as follows:
957
958@smallexample
959-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
960@end smallexample
961
962@kindex --pop-state
963@cindex pop state governing input file handling
67cecaba 964@item --pop-state
26278bb8
UD
965Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
966flags governing input file handling.
967
a712da20
NC
968@kindex -q
969@kindex --emit-relocs
970@cindex retain relocations in final executable
971@item -q
972@itemx --emit-relocs
ba1be17e 973Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
a712da20
NC
974Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
975order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
976in larger executables.
977
dbab7a7b
NC
978This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
979
4f471f39
RS
980@kindex --force-dynamic
981@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
982@item --force-dynamic
983Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
984to VxWorks targets.
985
252b5132
RH
986@cindex partial link
987@cindex relocatable output
988@kindex -r
1049f94e 989@kindex --relocatable
252b5132 990@item -r
1049f94e 991@itemx --relocatable
252b5132 992Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 993turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
252b5132
RH
994linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
995magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
996@code{OMAGIC}.
ff5dcc92 997@c ; see @option{-N}.
252b5132
RH
998If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
999linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1000constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1001
62bf86b4
HPN
1002When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1003partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1004relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1005example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1006with input files in other formats at all.
1007
252b5132
RH
1008This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1009
1010@kindex -R @var{file}
1011@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1012@cindex symbol-only input
1013@item -R @var{filename}
1014@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1015Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1016relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1017to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1018programs. You may use this option more than once.
1019
ff5dcc92 1020For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 1021followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 1022the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
1023
1024@kindex -s
1025@kindex --strip-all
1026@cindex strip all symbols
a1ab1d2a 1027@item -s
252b5132
RH
1028@itemx --strip-all
1029Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1030
1031@kindex -S
1032@kindex --strip-debug
1033@cindex strip debugger symbols
a1ab1d2a 1034@item -S
252b5132
RH
1035@itemx --strip-debug
1036Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1037
a70f34c0
NC
1038@kindex --strip-discarded
1039@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1040@item --strip-discarded
1041@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1042Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1043Enabled by default.
1044
252b5132
RH
1045@kindex -t
1046@kindex --trace
1047@cindex input files, displaying
a1ab1d2a 1048@item -t
252b5132 1049@itemx --trace
4f4690cd
AM
1050Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1051@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1052@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1053and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1054a linker bug report.
252b5132
RH
1055
1056@kindex -T @var{script}
1057@kindex --script=@var{script}
1058@cindex script files
1059@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1060@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1061Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
ff5dcc92 1062@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
252b5132 1063@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
114283d8
NC
1064output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1065the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1066specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1067options accumulate.
252b5132 1068
14be8564
L
1069@kindex -dT @var{script}
1070@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1071@cindex script files
1072@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1073@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1074Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1075
1076This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1077processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1078command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1079@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1080behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1081command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1082the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1083@samp{gcc}).
1084
252b5132
RH
1085@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1086@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1087@cindex undefined symbol
1088@item -u @var{symbol}
1089@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1090Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1091symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1092modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1093different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1094option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1095
0a618243
AB
1096If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1097into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1098undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1099instead.
1100
1101@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1102@cindex symbols, require defined
1103@cindex defined symbol
1104@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1105Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1106is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1107is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1108and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1109@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1110can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1111
252b5132
RH
1112@kindex -Ur
1113@cindex constructors
a1ab1d2a 1114@item -Ur
252b5132
RH
1115For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1116@samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1117turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
252b5132
RH
1118@emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1119It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1120with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1121be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1122@samp{-r} for the others.
1123
c005eb9e
AB
1124@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1125@cindex orphan sections
1126@cindex sections, orphan
1127@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1128Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1129specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1130
1131@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1132
1133@table @code
1134@item place
1135Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1136the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
d2732b69 1137@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
c005eb9e
AB
1138
1139@item discard
1140All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1141@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1142
1143@item warn
1144The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1145issue a warning.
1146
1147@item error
1148The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1149@end table
1150
1151The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1152
577a0623
AM
1153@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1155Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1156@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1157missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1158specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1159multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1160input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1161in a linker script.
a854a4a7 1162
252b5132
RH
1163@kindex -v
1164@kindex -V
1165@kindex --version
1166@cindex version
1167@item -v
1168@itemx --version
1169@itemx -V
ff5dcc92 1170Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
252b5132
RH
1171lists the supported emulations.
1172
1173@kindex -x
1174@kindex --discard-all
1175@cindex deleting local symbols
1176@item -x
1177@itemx --discard-all
1178Delete all local symbols.
1179
1180@kindex -X
1181@kindex --discard-locals
1182@cindex local symbols, deleting
a1ab1d2a 1183@item -X
252b5132 1184@itemx --discard-locals
3c68c38f
BW
1185Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1186system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1187or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
252b5132
RH
1188
1189@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1190@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1191@cindex symbol tracing
1192@item -y @var{symbol}
1193@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1194Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1195option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1196to prepend an underscore.
1197
1198This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1199don't know where the reference is coming from.
1200
1201@kindex -Y @var{path}
1202@item -Y @var{path}
1203Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1204for Solaris compatibility.
1205
1206@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1207@item -z @var{keyword}
cd6d6c15
NC
1208The recognized keywords are:
1209@table @samp
1210
e6e2dfbd
AM
1211@item bndplt
1212Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1213
1214@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1215@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1216@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1217@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1218Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1219to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1220@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1221@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1222@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1223@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1224Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1225
233a0083
L
1226@item cet-report=none
1227@itemx cet-report=warning
1228@itemx cet-report=error
1229Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1230GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1231section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1232linker not report missing properties in input files.
1233@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1234missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1235the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1236Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1237GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1238turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1239Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1240
cd6d6c15 1241@item combreloc
e6e2dfbd
AM
1242@itemx nocombreloc
1243Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1244dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
cd6d6c15 1245
b8871f35 1246@item common
e6e2dfbd
AM
1247@itemx nocommon
1248Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1249link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1250
1251@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1252Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1253layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1254using pages of this size.
b8871f35 1255
cd6d6c15 1256@item defs
97a232d7
NC
1257Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1258is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1259This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
cd6d6c15 1260
e6e2dfbd
AM
1261@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1262@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1263Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1264if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1265by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1266@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1267may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1268selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1269these options.
1270
6aa29e7b
JJ
1271@item execstack
1272Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1273
b039ef04
L
1274@item global
1275This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1276the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1277of subsequently loaded libraries.
1278
93ab9c0d
NC
1279@item globalaudit
1280This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1281This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1282setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1283tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
a05a5b64 1284the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
6c19b93b 1285all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
93ab9c0d 1286
e6e2dfbd
AM
1287@item ibtplt
1288Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1289Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1290
8df93cb5 1291@item ibt
e6e2dfbd
AM
1292Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1293to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1294Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1295
6f365fda
L
1296@item indirect-extern-access
1297@itemx noindirect-extern-access
1298Generate GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS in
1299.note.gnu.property section to indicate that object file requires
1300canonical function pointers and cannot be used with copy relocation.
1301This option also implies @option{noextern-protected-data} and
1302@option{nocopyreloc}. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1303
1304@option{noindirect-extern-access} removes
1305GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS from .note.gnu.property
1306section.
1307
cd6d6c15
NC
1308@item initfirst
1309This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1310It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1311before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1312the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1313the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1314objects.
1315
1316@item interpose
e6e2dfbd
AM
1317Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1318so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1319libraries not so marked.
cd6d6c15 1320
c3805e4c
VDM
1321@item unique
1322@itemx nounique
1323When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1324object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1325and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1326primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1327al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1328of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1329and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1330
279d901e
L
1331@item lam-u48
1332Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1333to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1334
1335@item lam-u57
1336Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1337to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1338
1339@item lam-u48-report=none
1340@itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1341@itemx lam-u48-report=error
1342Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1343property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1344@option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1345linker not report missing properties in input files.
1346@option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1347missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1348make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1349Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1350
1351@item lam-u57-report=none
1352@itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1353@itemx lam-u57-report=error
1354Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1355property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1356@option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1357linker not report missing properties in input files.
1358@option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1359missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1360make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1361Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1362
1363@item lam-report=none
1364@itemx lam-report=warning
1365@itemx lam-report=error
1366Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1367GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1368section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1369linker not report missing properties in input files.
1370@option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1371missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1372the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1373Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1374
5fa222e4
AM
1375@item lazy
1376When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1377dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1378the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1379Lazy binding is the default.
1380
cd6d6c15 1381@item loadfltr
e6e2dfbd 1382Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
cd6d6c15 1383
e6e2dfbd
AM
1384@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1385Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
cd6d6c15 1386
e6e2dfbd
AM
1387@item muldefs
1388Allow multiple definitions.
b8871f35 1389
cd6d6c15 1390@item nocopyreloc
daf220f0
AM
1391Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1392defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
cd6d6c15
NC
1393
1394@item nodefaultlib
e6e2dfbd
AM
1395Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1396should ignore any default library search paths.
cd6d6c15
NC
1397
1398@item nodelete
e6e2dfbd 1399Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
cd6d6c15
NC
1400
1401@item nodlopen
e6e2dfbd 1402Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
cd6d6c15
NC
1403
1404@item nodump
e6e2dfbd 1405Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
cd6d6c15 1406
6aa29e7b
JJ
1407@item noexecstack
1408Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1409
e6e2dfbd
AM
1410@item noextern-protected-data
1411Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1412library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1413used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1414generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1415module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1416i386 and x86-64.
8dfef1bd 1417
e6e2dfbd
AM
1418@item noreloc-overflow
1419Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1420relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1421overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
6aa29e7b 1422
cd6d6c15
NC
1423@item now
1424When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1425dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
e6e2dfbd
AM
1426when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1427function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1428called.
cd6d6c15
NC
1429
1430@item origin
e6e2dfbd 1431Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
cd6d6c15 1432
6aa29e7b 1433@item relro
e6e2dfbd 1434@itemx norelro
def5c83c
AM
1435Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1436specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1437relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1438than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
e6e2dfbd 1439Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
6aa29e7b 1440
68b00778
L
1441@item report-relative-reloc
1442Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1443Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1444
47acac12
L
1445@item separate-code
1446@itemx noseparate-code
1447Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1448specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1449be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1450code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1451
e6e2dfbd
AM
1452@item shstk
1453Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1454to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1455Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
24718e3b 1456
04c3a755 1457@item stack-size=@var{value}
e6e2dfbd 1458Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
04c3a755
NS
1459Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1460@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1461
8ee10e86
AM
1462@item start-stop-gc
1463@itemx nostart-stop-gc
1464@cindex start-stop-gc
1465When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1466section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1467input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1468@code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1469@code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1470linker. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1471sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1472were not defined. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1473definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1474object file or linker script. Such a definition will prevent the
1475linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1476@code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1477treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1478
cae64165
RM
1479@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1480@cindex visibility
1481@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1482Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1483@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1484Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1485@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1486start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1487compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1488recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1489programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1490between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1491
e6e2dfbd
AM
1492@item text
1493@itemx notext
1494@itemx textoff
a6dbf402
L
1495Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1496or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1497report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
48580982 1498
97a232d7
NC
1499@item undefs
1500Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1501either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1502This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1503
2d95647b
L
1504@item unique-symbol
1505@itemx nounique-symbol
1506Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1507".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1508is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1509
b0ab0693 1510@item x86-64-baseline
32930e4e
L
1511@item x86-64-v2
1512@item x86-64-v3
1513@itemx x86-64-v4
1514Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
b0ab0693 1515@option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
32930e4e
L
1516@option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1517@option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1518@option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1519Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1520
cd6d6c15
NC
1521@end table
1522
ece2d90e 1523Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
252b5132
RH
1524
1525@kindex -(
1526@cindex groups of archives
1527@item -( @var{archives} -)
1528@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1529The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1530either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1531
1532The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1533references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1534the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1535archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1536object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1537would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
5d3db3e2 1538they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
252b5132
RH
1539resolved.
1540
1541Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1542it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1543more archives.
1544
69da35b5
NC
1545@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1546@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1547@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1548@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1549Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
2ca22b03 1550recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
69da35b5
NC
1551and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1552the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1553behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1554so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1555restore the old behaviour.
2ca22b03 1556
4a43e768
AM
1557@kindex --as-needed
1558@kindex --no-as-needed
1559@item --as-needed
1560@itemx --no-as-needed
1561This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
ddbb8a31 1562on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
4a43e768
AM
1563the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1564on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
ddbb8a31 1565needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
ffa9430d
AM
1566emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1567non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1240be6b
AM
1568the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1569non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
ffa9430d
AM
1570Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1571the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1572needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1573from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
4a43e768 1574
6418520e
NC
1575Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has
1576an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and
1577@option{--rpath-link} options. See the description of
1578@option{--rpath-link} for more details.
1579
e56f61be
L
1580@kindex --add-needed
1581@kindex --no-add-needed
1582@item --add-needed
1583@itemx --no-add-needed
ddbb8a31
NC
1584These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1585their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1586options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1587and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
e56f61be 1588
252b5132
RH
1589@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1590@item -assert @var{keyword}
1591This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1592
1593@kindex -Bdynamic
1594@kindex -dy
1595@kindex -call_shared
1596@item -Bdynamic
1597@itemx -dy
1598@itemx -call_shared
1599Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1600for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1601default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1602for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1603multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
da8bce14 1604@option{-l} options which follow it.
252b5132 1605
a1ab1d2a
UD
1606@kindex -Bgroup
1607@item -Bgroup
1608Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1609section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1610object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
560e09e9
NC
1611@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1612only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
a1ab1d2a 1613
252b5132
RH
1614@kindex -Bstatic
1615@kindex -dn
1616@kindex -non_shared
1617@kindex -static
a1ab1d2a 1618@item -Bstatic
252b5132
RH
1619@itemx -dn
1620@itemx -non_shared
1621@itemx -static
1622Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1623platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1624variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1625may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
560e09e9 1626library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
e9156f74
NC
1627option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1628option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1629shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1630references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
ece2d90e 1631libraries.
252b5132
RH
1632
1633@kindex -Bsymbolic
1634@item -Bsymbolic
1635When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1636definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1637for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1914e264
AM
1638within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1639platforms which support shared libraries.
252b5132 1640
40b36307
L
1641@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1642@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1643When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
c0065db7 1644symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
40b36307 1645This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1914e264 1646libraries.
40b36307 1647
cf893b0e
FS
1648@kindex -Bno-symbolic
1649@item -Bno-symbolic
1650This option can cancel previously specified @samp{-Bsymbolic} and
1651@samp{-Bsymbolic-functions}.
1652
55255dae
L
1653@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1654@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1655Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1656typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1657global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1658within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1659to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1660in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1661which support shared libraries.
1662
1663The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1664scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1665
40b36307
L
1666@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1667@item --dynamic-list-data
1668Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1669
1670@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1671@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1672Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1673is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1674
0b8a70d9
L
1675@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1676@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1677Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1678
252b5132
RH
1679@kindex --check-sections
1680@kindex --no-check-sections
1681@item --check-sections
308b1ffd 1682@itemx --no-check-sections
252b5132 1683Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
7d816a17 1684been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
252b5132
RH
1685perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1686suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1687allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
a05a5b64 1688restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
02b0b1aa
NS
1689Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1690force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1691option.
252b5132 1692
ddbb8a31
NC
1693@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1694@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1695@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1696@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
9d5777a3 1697This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
ddbb8a31 1698by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
08efffb8 1699command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
ddbb8a31 1700output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
08efffb8 1701input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
ddbb8a31 1702specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
08efffb8
MM
1703follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1704behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
ddbb8a31
NC
1705
1706This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
08efffb8
MM
1707libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1708mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1709their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1710required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1711the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1712dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
ddbb8a31
NC
1713symbols.
1714
252b5132
RH
1715@cindex cross reference table
1716@kindex --cref
1717@item --cref
1718Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1719generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1720Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1721
1722The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1723easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1724sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1725symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
049c1c8e
NC
1726definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1727where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1728symbol are listed.
252b5132 1729
5dba6f05
NA
1730@cindex ctf variables
1731@kindex --ctf-variables
1732@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1733@item --ctf-variables
1734@item --no-ctf-variables
1735The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1736types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1737table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1738conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1739usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1740@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1741The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1742
1743@cindex ctf type sharing
1744@kindex --ctf-share-types
1745@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1746Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1747
1748@table @samp
1749@item share-unconflicted
1750Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1751where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1752translation unit. This is the default.
1753
1754@item share-duplicated
1755Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1756dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1757dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1758always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1759larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1760large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1761consumer at runtime.
1762@end table
1763
4818e05f
AM
1764@cindex common allocation
1765@kindex --no-define-common
1766@item --no-define-common
1767This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1768The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1769@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1770
1771The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1772the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1773of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1774forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1775Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1776from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1777This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1778and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1779duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1780paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1781
7bdf4127
AB
1782@cindex group allocation in linker script
1783@cindex section groups
1784@cindex COMDAT
1785@kindex --force-group-allocation
1786@item --force-group-allocation
1787This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1788normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1789default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1790change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1791command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1792effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1793
252b5132 1794@cindex symbols, from command line
2509a395
SL
1795@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1796@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
252b5132
RH
1797Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1798address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1799times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1800limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1801context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1802symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1803constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
66bc8739
AM
1804using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1805@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1806equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
252b5132 1807
54874444
AB
1808The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1809in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1810symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1811placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1812the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1813consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1814@samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1815you are trying to achieve.
1816
252b5132 1817@cindex demangling, from command line
28c309a2 1818@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132 1819@kindex --no-demangle
28c309a2 1820@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132
RH
1821@itemx --no-demangle
1822These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1823and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1824present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1825underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
a1ab1d2a
UD
1826mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1827different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1828to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
28c309a2
NC
1829demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1830is set. These options may be used to override the default.
252b5132
RH
1831
1832@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
506eee22 1833@kindex -I@var{file}
2509a395
SL
1834@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1835@item -I@var{file}
1836@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
252b5132
RH
1837Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1838generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1839linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1840doing.
1841
9b8b325a
RF
1842@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1843@item --no-dynamic-linker
1844When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1845linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1846executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1847entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1848
a70f34c0
NC
1849@kindex --embedded-relocs
1850@item --embedded-relocs
1851This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
a094d01f 1852that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
a70f34c0
NC
1853is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1854targets.
1855
3f0a5f17
ME
1856@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1857@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1858Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1859in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1860
7ce691ae 1861@kindex --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd 1862@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
7ce691ae 1863@item --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd
NC
1864@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1865Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1866with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
7ce691ae 1867
252b5132
RH
1868@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1869@item --force-exe-suffix
1870Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1871
1872If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1873@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1874the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1875option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1876Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1877it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1878
1879@kindex --gc-sections
1880@kindex --no-gc-sections
1881@cindex garbage collection
c17d87de
NC
1882@item --gc-sections
1883@itemx --no-gc-sections
252b5132 1884Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
ac69cbc6 1885targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
b3549761 1886performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
0f088b2a
KT
1887@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1888collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1889implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
252b5132 1890
d5465ba2
AM
1891@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1892examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1893symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1894command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1895referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1896libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1897referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1898the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
b69e1ff3
CC
1899relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1900@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
d5465ba2 1901
ac69cbc6 1902This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
9d5777a3 1903@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
b69e1ff3
CC
1904specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1905@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1906command in the linker script.
ac69cbc6 1907
99fabbc9
JL
1908As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
1909@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
1910
c17d87de
NC
1911@kindex --print-gc-sections
1912@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1913@cindex garbage collection
1914@item --print-gc-sections
1915@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1916List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1917printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1918collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1919default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1920be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1921line.
1922
22185505 1923@kindex --gc-keep-exported
1924@cindex garbage collection
1925@item --gc-keep-exported
1926When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1927collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1928default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1929executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1930collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1931Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1932it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1933ELF format targets.
1934
30824704
RM
1935@kindex --print-output-format
1936@cindex output format
1937@item --print-output-format
1938Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1939other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1940in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1941
3604cb1f
TG
1942@kindex --print-memory-usage
1943@cindex memory usage
1944@item --print-memory-usage
1945Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1946the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1947quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1948headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1949parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1950
1951@smallexample
1952Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1953 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1954 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1955@end smallexample
1956
252b5132
RH
1957@cindex help
1958@cindex usage
1959@kindex --help
1960@item --help
1961Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1962
ea20a7da
CC
1963@kindex --target-help
1964@item --target-help
a094d01f 1965Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
ea20a7da 1966
2509a395
SL
1967@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1968@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
252b5132 1969Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
2c72361c
NC
1970@option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
1971@code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
1972
1973Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
1974written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
1975inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
1976file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
1977@code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
1978output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
1979@var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
1980
1981@smallexample
1982 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1983 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1984 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1985 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1986 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
1987 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1988 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
1989 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
1990 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
1991 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
1992@end smallexample
1993
1994It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
1995
1996If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
1997operation.
252b5132
RH
1998
1999@cindex memory usage
2000@kindex --no-keep-memory
2001@item --no-keep-memory
ff5dcc92
SC
2002@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
2003symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
252b5132 2004instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
ff5dcc92 2005necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
252b5132
RH
2006while linking a large executable.
2007
2008@kindex --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 2009@kindex -z defs
97a232d7 2010@kindex -z undefs
252b5132 2011@item --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 2012@itemx -z defs
560e09e9
NC
2013Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
2014is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
2015The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
2016behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
ece2d90e 2017libraries being linked in.
252b5132 2018
97a232d7
NC
2019The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
2020
aa713662
L
2021@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2022@kindex -z muldefs
2023@item --allow-multiple-definition
2024@itemx -z muldefs
2025Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2026report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2027first definition will be used.
2028
b79e8c78 2029@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2030@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
b79e8c78 2031@item --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2032@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
903249d7 2033Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
560e09e9
NC
2034This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2035determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2036shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
2037how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2038
903249d7
NC
2039The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2040referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2041an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2042a shared library.
2043
2044The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2045libraries specified at link time are that:
2046
2047@itemize @bullet
2048@item
2049A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2050that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2051resolvable at load time.
2052@item
2053There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2054symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2055
2056The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2057select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2058architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2059appropriate memset function.
2060@end itemize
b79e8c78 2061
23ae20f5
NC
2062@kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2063@item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2064If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2065@var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2066only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2067libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
93cf38c0
NC
2068``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
2069undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2070will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
23ae20f5
NC
2071might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2072error message will be displayed.
2073
2074The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2075switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2076
31941635
L
2077@kindex --no-undefined-version
2078@item --no-undefined-version
2079Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2080it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2081will be issued instead.
2082
3e3b46e5
PB
2083@kindex --default-symver
2084@item --default-symver
2085Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
fc0e6df6
PB
2086exported symbols.
2087
2088@kindex --default-imported-symver
2089@item --default-imported-symver
2090Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2091imported symbols.
3e3b46e5 2092
252b5132
RH
2093@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2094@item --no-warn-mismatch
ff5dcc92 2095Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
252b5132
RH
2096files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2097been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
ff5dcc92 2098This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
252b5132
RH
2099errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2100have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2101inappropriate.
2102
fe7929ce
AM
2103@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2104@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2105Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2106library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2107
252b5132
RH
2108@kindex --no-whole-archive
2109@item --no-whole-archive
ff5dcc92 2110Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
252b5132
RH
2111archive files.
2112
2113@cindex output file after errors
2114@kindex --noinhibit-exec
2115@item --noinhibit-exec
2116Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2117Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2118errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2119when it issues any error whatsoever.
2120
0a9c1c8e
CD
2121@kindex -nostdlib
2122@item -nostdlib
2123Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2124command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2125(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2126
252b5132 2127@ifclear SingleFormat
2509a395
SL
2128@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2129@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
2130@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2131file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 2132@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
ff5dcc92
SC
2133object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2134object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
2135should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2136usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2137name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2138list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2139command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2140this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2141@end ifclear
2142
76359541
TP
2143@kindex --out-implib
2144@item --out-implib @var{file}
2145Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2146the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2147library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2148may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2149behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2150step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2151the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2152
36af4a4e
JJ
2153@kindex -pie
2154@kindex --pic-executable
2155@item -pie
2156@itemx --pic-executable
2157@cindex position independent executables
2158Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2159ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2160libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
7e7d5768 2161address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
36af4a4e
JJ
2162normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2163defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2164
e8f6c2a5
FS
2165@kindex -no-pie
2166@item -no-pie
2167@cindex position dependent executables
2168Create a position dependent executable. This is the default.
2169
252b5132
RH
2170@kindex -qmagic
2171@item -qmagic
2172This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2173
2174@kindex -Qy
2175@item -Qy
2176This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2177
2178@kindex --relax
2179@cindex synthesizing linker
2180@cindex relaxing addressing modes
28d5f677 2181@cindex --no-relax
252b5132 2182@item --relax
28d5f677 2183@itemx --no-relax
a1ab1d2a 2184An option with machine dependent effects.
252b5132
RH
2185@ifset GENERIC
2186This option is only supported on a few targets.
2187@end ifset
2188@ifset H8300
ff5dcc92 2189@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
252b5132 2190@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
2191@ifset XTENSA
2192@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2193@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
2194@ifset M68HC11
2195@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2196@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
2197@ifset NIOSII
2198@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2199@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
2200@ifset POWERPC
2201@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2202@end ifset
252b5132 2203
ccd9fae5 2204On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
28d5f677
NC
2205global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2206addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2207synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
11e7fd74 2208instructions, and combining constant values.
252b5132
RH
2209
2210On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2211debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2212@ifset GENERIC
28d5f677
NC
2213This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2214family of processors.
252b5132
RH
2215@end ifset
2216
ccd9fae5
NC
2217On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2218@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
28d5f677 2219
ccd9fae5
NC
2220On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2221and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2222
252b5132
RH
2223@cindex retaining specified symbols
2224@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2225@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2509a395
SL
2226@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2227@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
252b5132
RH
2228Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2229discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2230symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2231@ifset GENERIC
2232(such as VxWorks)
2233@end ifset
2234where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2235run-time memory.
2236
2237@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2238or symbols needed for relocations.
2239
2240You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2241line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2242
2243@ifset GENERIC
2509a395 2244@item -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2245@cindex runtime library search path
2509a395 2246@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2247Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
ff5dcc92 2248linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
252b5132 2249arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
c1b00498
MR
2250them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2251
2252The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2253are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2254description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2255in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2256have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2257
2258If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2259contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2260is defined.
252b5132 2261
ff5dcc92 2262The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
d8506323 2263SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
ff5dcc92
SC
2264@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2265runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2266options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2267gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
b45619c0 2268file systems.
252b5132 2269
ff5dcc92 2270For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 2271followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 2272the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
2273@end ifset
2274
2275@ifset GENERIC
2276@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2509a395
SL
2277@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2278@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
252b5132
RH
2279When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2280happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2281of the input files.
2282
2283When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2284non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2285shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
ff5dcc92 2286explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
252b5132 2287specifies the first set of directories to search. The
ff5dcc92 2288@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
252b5132
RH
2289either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2290appearing multiple times.
2291
e680a6b6
NC
2292The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2293directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2294containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2295and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
229664-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2297
2298The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2299@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2300supported.
2301
28c309a2
NC
2302This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2303that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2304is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2305runtime linker would do.
2306
252b5132 2307The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
ece2d90e 2308libraries:
d8e4137b 2309
252b5132
RH
2310@enumerate
2311@item
ff5dcc92 2312Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
252b5132 2313@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2314Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2315between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2316specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2317used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
ece2d90e
NC
2318at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2319by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2320the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
252b5132 2321@item
e2a83dd0
NC
2322On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2323@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2324environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
252b5132 2325@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2326On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2327directories specified using @option{-L} options.
252b5132 2328@item
a1b8d843 2329For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
e2a83dd0 2330variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
252b5132 2331@item
ec4eb78a
L
2332For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2333@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2334libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2335@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2336@item
d8e4137b
NC
2337For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2338exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2339to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2340defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2341configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2342@item
2343For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2344the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2345header file.
2346@item
364d7729
AM
2347Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a
2348linker script given on the command line, including scripts specified
2349by @option{-T} (but not @option{-dT}).
2350@item
2351The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2352@item
2353Any directories specified by a plugin LDPT_SET_EXTRA_LIBRARY_PATH.
2354@item
2355Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a default
2356linker script.
252b5132
RH
2357@end enumerate
2358
6418520e
NC
2359Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat: If
2360the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library
2361is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this
2362library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so}
2363@emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search
2364directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and}
2365this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for
2366@file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead
2367of the first.
2368
252b5132
RH
2369If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2370warning and continue with the link.
6418520e 2371
252b5132
RH
2372@end ifset
2373
2374@kindex -shared
2375@kindex -Bshareable
2376@item -shared
2377@itemx -Bshareable
2378@cindex shared libraries
2379Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2380and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
ff5dcc92 2381shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
252b5132
RH
2382undefined symbols in the link.
2383
252b5132 2384@kindex --sort-common
2509a395
SL
2385@item --sort-common
2386@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2387@itemx --sort-common=descending
de7dd2bd
NC
2388This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2389ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2390sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2391eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2392between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2393specified, then descending order is assumed.
252b5132 2394
2509a395
SL
2395@kindex --sort-section=name
2396@item --sort-section=name
bcaa7b3e
L
2397This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2398patterns in the linker script.
2399
2509a395
SL
2400@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2401@item --sort-section=alignment
bcaa7b3e
L
2402This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2403patterns in the linker script.
2404
a70f34c0
NC
2405@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2406@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2407This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2408.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2409post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2410
252b5132 2411@kindex --split-by-file
2509a395 2412@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
ff5dcc92 2413Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
a854a4a7
AM
2414each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2415size of 1 if not given.
252b5132
RH
2416
2417@kindex --split-by-reloc
2509a395 2418@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
a854a4a7 2419Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
252b5132 2420output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
a854a4a7 2421This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
252b5132
RH
2422certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2423cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2424that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2425support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2426input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2427more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
a854a4a7 2428many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
252b5132
RH
2429
2430@kindex --stats
2431@item --stats
2432Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2433as execution time and memory usage.
2434
2509a395 2435@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
e2243057
RS
2436@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2437Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2438configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2439that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2440
a70f34c0
NC
2441@kindex --task-link
2442@item --task-link
2443This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2444file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2445
252b5132
RH
2446@kindex --traditional-format
2447@cindex traditional format
2448@item --traditional-format
ff5dcc92
SC
2449For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2450the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
252b5132
RH
2451use the traditional format instead.
2452
2453@cindex dbx
ff5dcc92 2454For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
252b5132
RH
2455symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2456full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2457@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
ff5dcc92 2458trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
252b5132
RH
2459combine duplicate entries.
2460
2509a395
SL
2461@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2462@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
176355da
NC
2463Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2464address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2465times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2466line.
2467@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2468for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2469@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2470should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2471sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2472
2509a395
SL
2473@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2474@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2475@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
252b5132 2476@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2509a395
SL
2477@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2478@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2479@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2480Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
a6e02871 2481@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
252b5132 2482
2509a395
SL
2483@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2484@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
258795f5 2485@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2b8c06a3
L
2486When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2487byte of the text segment.
258795f5 2488
9d5777a3
RM
2489@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2490@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2491@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2492When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2493the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2494text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2495
0d705e9f
AM
2496@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2497@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2498@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2499When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2500model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2501
560e09e9
NC
2502@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2503@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2504Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2505values for @samp{method}:
2506
2507@table @samp
2508@item ignore-all
da8bce14 2509Do not report any unresolved symbols.
560e09e9
NC
2510
2511@item report-all
da8bce14 2512Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
560e09e9
NC
2513
2514@item ignore-in-object-files
2515Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2516ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2517
2518@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2519Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2520ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2521when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2522libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2523command line.
2524@end table
2525
2526The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2527by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2528
2529Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2530unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2531can change this to a warning.
2532
1715a13c
L
2533@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2534@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
252b5132 2535@item --dll-verbose
1715a13c 2536@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
ff5dcc92 2537Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
252b5132 2538supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
1715a13c
L
2539the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2540argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
252b5132
RH
2541
2542@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2543@cindex version script, symbol versions
2509a395 2544@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
252b5132
RH
2545Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2546used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
36f63dca 2547about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
09e2aba4
DK
2548is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2549see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2550use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2551symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2552@xref{WIN32}.
252b5132 2553
7ce691ae 2554@kindex --warn-common
252b5132
RH
2555@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2556@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2557@item --warn-common
2558Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
11e7fd74 2559a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
252b5132
RH
2560but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2561you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
11e7fd74 2562Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
252b5132
RH
2563warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2564
2565There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2566
2567@table @samp
2568@item int i = 1;
2569A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2570file.
2571
2572@item extern int i;
2573An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2574There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2575variable somewhere.
2576
2577@item int i;
2578A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2579variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2580The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2581single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2582size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2583a definition of the same variable.
2584@end table
2585
2586The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2587Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2588just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2589encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2590a common symbol.
2591
2592@enumerate
2593@item
2594Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2595definition for the symbol.
2596@smallexample
2597@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2598 overridden by definition
2599@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2600@end smallexample
2601
2602@item
2603Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2604the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2605except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2606@smallexample
2607@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2608 overriding common
2609@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2610@end smallexample
2611
2612@item
2613Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2614@smallexample
2615@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2616 of `@var{symbol}'
2617@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2618@end smallexample
2619
2620@item
2621Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2622@smallexample
2623@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2624 overridden by larger common
2625@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2626@end smallexample
2627
2628@item
2629Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2630the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2631encountered in a different order.
2632@smallexample
2633@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2634 overriding smaller common
2635@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2636@end smallexample
2637@end enumerate
2638
2639@kindex --warn-constructors
2640@item --warn-constructors
2641Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2642object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2643detect the use of global constructors.
2644
2645@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2646@item --warn-multiple-gp
2647Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2648This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2649Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2650section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2651of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2652base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2653base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2654bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2655large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2656values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2657option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2658
2659@kindex --warn-once
2660@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2661@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2662@item --warn-once
2663Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2664which refers to it.
2665
2666@kindex --warn-section-align
2667@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2668@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2669@item --warn-section-align
2670Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2671alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2672The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2673is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2674the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2675
a6dbf402
L
2676@kindex --warn-textrel
2677@item --warn-textrel
2678Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2679or shared object.
8fdd7217 2680
a0c402a5
L
2681@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2682@item --warn-alternate-em
2683Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2684
560e09e9
NC
2685@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2686@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2687If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2688@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2689This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2690
2691@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2692@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2693This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2694it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2695
252b5132
RH
2696@kindex --whole-archive
2697@cindex including an entire archive
2698@item --whole-archive
2699For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
ff5dcc92 2700@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
252b5132
RH
2701in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2702files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2703library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2704library. This option may be used more than once.
2705
7ec229ce 2706Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
ff5dcc92
SC
2707about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2708Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
7ec229ce
DD
2709list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2710your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2711
2509a395
SL
2712@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2713@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
252b5132
RH
2714Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2715@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2716undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2717@var{symbol}.
2718
2719This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2720wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2721wishes to call the system function, it should call
2722@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2723
2724Here is a trivial example:
2725
2726@smallexample
2727void *
cc2f008e 2728__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
252b5132 2729@{
cc2f008e 2730 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
252b5132
RH
2731 return __real_malloc (c);
2732@}
2733@end smallexample
2734
ff5dcc92 2735If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
252b5132
RH
2736all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2737instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2738call the real @code{malloc} function.
2739
2740You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
ff5dcc92 2741links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
252b5132
RH
2742you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2743file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2744call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2745
4ea904ed
SH
2746Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2747internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2748@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2749@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2750
2751@smallexample
2752int
2753f (void)
2754@{
2755 return 123;
2756@}
2757
2758int
2759g (void)
2760@{
2761 return f();
2762@}
2763@end smallexample
2764
6aa29e7b 2765@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b 2766@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
6aa29e7b 2767@item --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b
NC
2768@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2769Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2770(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2771section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
6aa29e7b 2772
e41b3a13
JJ
2773@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2774@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2775Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2776generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2777if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2778
6c1439be
L
2779@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2780@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2781@item --enable-new-dtags
2782@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2783This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2784systems may not understand them. If you specify
b1b00fcc
MF
2785@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2786and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
ff5dcc92 2787If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
6c1439be
L
2788created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2789those options are only available for ELF systems.
2790
2d643429 2791@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
e185dd51 2792@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2d643429
NC
2793Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2794close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2795time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2796increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2797value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2798
fdc90cb4
JJ
2799@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2800@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2801Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2802@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2803new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2804the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
c8455dc9
NC
2805hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2806but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
fdc90cb4 2807
0ce398f1
L
2808@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2809@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2810@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2811@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2812@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2813@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2814@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2815@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
9af89fba
NC
2816On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2817compressed using zlib.
2818
2819@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2820sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2821DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2822instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2823also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2824sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2825
2826The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2827@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2828
2829Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2830sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2831for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2832uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2833
2834The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2835involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2836default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2837@option{--help} option.
0ce398f1 2838
35835446
JR
2839@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2840@item --reduce-memory-overheads
2841This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
f2a8f148 2842linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
35835446 2843for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2d643429
NC
2844about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2845
4f9c04f7 2846Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2d643429 28471021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
a85785bc 2848run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2d643429
NC
2849has been used.
2850
2851The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2852enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
35835446 2853
a8dde0a2
L
2854@kindex --max-cache-size=@var{size}
2855@item --max-cache-size=@var{size}
2856@command{ld} normally caches the relocation information and symbol tables
2857of input files in memory with the unlimited size. This option sets the
2858maximum cache size to @var{size}.
2859
c0065db7
RM
2860@kindex --build-id
2861@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2862@item --build-id
2863@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
61e2488c 2864Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
6033bf41 2865or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
61e2488c
JT
2866unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2867@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2868@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2869@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2870the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2871string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2872@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2873is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
24382dca
RM
2874
2875The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2876that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2877unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2878to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2879file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2880string identifying the original linked file does not change.
c0065db7
RM
2881
2882Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2883@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
252b5132
RH
2884@end table
2885
0285c67d
NC
2886@c man end
2887
36f63dca 2888@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
252b5132 2889
0285c67d
NC
2890@c man begin OPTIONS
2891
ff5dcc92 2892The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
252b5132
RH
2893the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2894normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2895use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2896@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2897like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2898symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2899object file).
2900
2901In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
a05a5b64 2902support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
252b5132
RH
2903PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2904values by either a space or an equals sign.
2905
ff5dcc92 2906@table @gcctabopt
252b5132
RH
2907
2908@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2909@item --add-stdcall-alias
2910If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2911as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
bb10df36 2912[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2913
2914@kindex --base-file
2915@item --base-file @var{file}
2916Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2917addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2918@file{dlltool}.
bb10df36 2919[This is an i386 PE specific option]
252b5132
RH
2920
2921@kindex --dll
2922@item --dll
2923Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
ff5dcc92 2924@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
252b5132 2925file.
bb10df36 2926[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2927
88183869
DK
2928@kindex --enable-long-section-names
2929@kindex --disable-long-section-names
2930@item --enable-long-section-names
2931@itemx --disable-long-section-names
56e6cf80 2932The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
88183869 2933the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
56e6cf80
NC
2934for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2935fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
88183869
DK
2936to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2937allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2938disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2939generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2940as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
9d5777a3
RM
2941with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2942GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3efd345c
DK
2943information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2944option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2945section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
2946when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
2947image and not stripping symbols.
88183869
DK
2948[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
2949
252b5132
RH
2950@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
2951@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
2952@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
2953@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
2954If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
36f63dca 2955do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
252b5132
RH
2956only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
2957resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
2958undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
2959@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
2960to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
2961warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
2962import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
ff5dcc92 2963to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
252b5132 2964feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
ff5dcc92 2965@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
252b5132 2966mismatches are considered to be errors.
bb10df36 2967[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2968
522f09cd
KT
2969@kindex --leading-underscore
2970@kindex --no-leading-underscore
2971@item --leading-underscore
2972@itemx --no-leading-underscore
2973For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
2974in target's description. By this option it is possible to
2975disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
2976
252b5132
RH
2977@cindex DLLs, creating
2978@kindex --export-all-symbols
2979@item --export-all-symbols
2980If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
2981be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
2982otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
2983explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
2984attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
2985option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
ece2d90e 2986@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
b044cda1 2987@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
ece2d90e
NC
2988exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
2989re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
2990such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
2991@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
b044cda1
CW
2992@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
2993Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
2994not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
ece2d90e 2995extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
b044cda1 2996(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
ece2d90e 2997These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
b044cda1 2998@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
ece2d90e 2999@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
b044cda1 3000@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
ece2d90e 3001@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
bb10df36 3002[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3003
3004@kindex --exclude-symbols
1d0a3c9c 3005@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
252b5132
RH
3006Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
3007exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
bb10df36 3008[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3009
2927aaca
NC
3010@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
3011@item --exclude-all-symbols
3012Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
3013[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3014
252b5132
RH
3015@kindex --file-alignment
3016@item --file-alignment
3017Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
3018file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
3019512.
bb10df36 3020[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3021
3022@cindex heap size
3023@kindex --heap
3024@item --heap @var{reserve}
3025@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3026Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3027to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3028committed.
bb10df36 3029[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3030
3031@cindex image base
3032@kindex --image-base
3033@item --image-base @var{value}
3034Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
3035the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
3036is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
3037your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
3038other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
3039for dlls.
bb10df36 3040[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3041
3042@kindex --kill-at
3043@item --kill-at
3044If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
3045symbols before they are exported.
bb10df36 3046[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3047
26d2d8a2
BF
3048@kindex --large-address-aware
3049@item --large-address-aware
b45619c0 3050If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
26d2d8a2 3051header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
b45619c0 3052greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
26d2d8a2
BF
3053or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3054section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3055[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3056
f69a2f97
NC
3057@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3058@item --disable-large-address-aware
3059Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3060This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3061driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3062addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3063[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3064
252b5132
RH
3065@kindex --major-image-version
3066@item --major-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3067Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
bb10df36 3068[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3069
3070@kindex --major-os-version
3071@item --major-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3072Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3073[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3074
3075@kindex --major-subsystem-version
3076@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3077Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3078[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3079
3080@kindex --minor-image-version
3081@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3082Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3083[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3084
3085@kindex --minor-os-version
3086@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3087Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3088[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3089
3090@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3091@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3092Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3093[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3094
3095@cindex DEF files, creating
3096@cindex DLLs, creating
3097@kindex --output-def
3098@item --output-def @var{file}
3099The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3100file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3101(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3102library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3103automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
bb10df36 3104[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3105
b044cda1 3106@cindex DLLs, creating
b044cda1
CW
3107@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3108@item --enable-auto-image-base
d0e6d77b
CF
3109@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3110Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3111@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3112By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3113for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3114execution are avoided.
bb10df36 3115[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3116
3117@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3118@item --disable-auto-image-base
3119Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3120user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3121default.
bb10df36 3122[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3123
3124@cindex DLLs, linking to
3125@kindex --dll-search-prefix
3126@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
489d0400 3127When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
ece2d90e 3128search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
560e09e9 3129@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
b044cda1
CW
3130between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3131uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
ece2d90e 3132@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
bb10df36 3133[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3134
3135@kindex --enable-auto-import
3136@item --enable-auto-import
ece2d90e 3137Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
317ff008
EB
3138DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3139mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3140[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3141
3142The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3143feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3144
3145Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3146of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3147PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
4d8907ac 3148
e2a83dd0
NC
3149Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3150data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3151placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3152around a problem with consts that is described here:
3153http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3154
4d8907ac
DS
3155Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3156see this message:
0d888aac 3157
ece2d90e 3158"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
0d888aac
CW
3159documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3160
ece2d90e
NC
3161This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3162ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
c0065db7
RM
3163allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3164fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3165constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2f8d8971
NC
3166multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3167this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3168of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3169the warning, and exit.
3170
3171There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3172data type of the exported variable:
0d888aac 3173
2fa9fc65
NC
3174One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3175of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
560e09e9 3176this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2fa9fc65 3177
c0065db7
RM
3178A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3179that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3180there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
0d888aac
CW
3181a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3182
3183@example
3184extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3185extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3186 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3187@end example
3188
3189or
3190
3191@example
3192extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3193extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3194 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3195@end example
3196
c0065db7 3197For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
2f8d8971 3198is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
0d888aac
CW
3199
3200@example
3201extern struct s extern_struct;
c0065db7 3202extern_struct.field -->
0d888aac
CW
3203 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3204@end example
3205
c406afaf
NC
3206or
3207
3208@example
3209extern long long extern_ll;
3210extern_ll -->
3211 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3212@end example
3213
2fa9fc65 3214A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
c0065db7 3215'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
11e7fd74 3216@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
0d888aac 3217requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
c0065db7
RM
3218building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3219merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3220between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
0d888aac
CW
3221constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3222
3223Original:
3224@example
3225--foo.h
3226extern int arr[];
3227--foo.c
3228#include "foo.h"
3229void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3230 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3231@}
3232@end example
3233
3234Solution 1:
3235@example
3236--foo.h
3237extern int arr[];
3238--foo.c
3239#include "foo.h"
3240void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3241 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3242 volatile int *parr = arr;
3243 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3244@}
3245@end example
3246
3247Solution 2:
3248@example
3249--foo.h
3250/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3251#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3252 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3253#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3254#else
3255#define FOO_IMPORT
3256#endif
3257extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3258--foo.c
3259#include "foo.h"
3260void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3261 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3262@}
3263@end example
3264
c0065db7 3265A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
0d888aac
CW
3266library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3267for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3268functions).
b044cda1
CW
3269
3270@kindex --disable-auto-import
3271@item --disable-auto-import
c0065db7 3272Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
b044cda1 3273@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3274[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3275
2fa9fc65
NC
3276@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3277@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3278If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3279that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3280a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
c0065db7 3281environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
bb10df36 3282[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65
NC
3283
3284@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3285@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
317ff008 3286Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3287[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65 3288
b044cda1
CW
3289@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3290@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3291Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
bb10df36 3292[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3293
252b5132
RH
3294@kindex --section-alignment
3295@item --section-alignment
3296Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3297addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
bb10df36 3298[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3299
3300@cindex stack size
3301@kindex --stack
3302@item --stack @var{reserve}
3303@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3304Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3305to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3306committed.
bb10df36 3307[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3308
3309@kindex --subsystem
3310@item --subsystem @var{which}
3311@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3312@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3313Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3314legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
33f362e1
NC
3315@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3316the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3317@var{which}.
bb10df36 3318[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3319
2f563b51
DK
3320The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3321of the PE file header:
3322[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3323
2d5c3743
NC
3324@kindex --high-entropy-va
3325@item --high-entropy-va
514b4e19 3326@itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
2d5c3743 3327Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
514b4e19
JD
3328(ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3329
dc9bd8c9
HD
3330This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3331@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2d5c3743 3332
2f563b51
DK
3333@kindex --dynamicbase
3334@item --dynamicbase
514b4e19 3335@itemx --disable-dynamicbase
2f563b51
DK
3336The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3337randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
514b4e19
JD
3338Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3339can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
dc9bd8c9 3340This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2f563b51
DK
3341
3342@kindex --forceinteg
3343@item --forceinteg
514b4e19
JD
3344@itemx --disable-forceinteg
3345Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3346default.
2f563b51
DK
3347
3348@kindex --nxcompat
3349@item --nxcompat
514b4e19 3350@item --disable-nxcompat
2f563b51 3351The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
514b4e19
JD
3352This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3353targets. The option is enabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3354
3355@kindex --no-isolation
3356@item --no-isolation
514b4e19 3357@itemx --disable-no-isolation
2f563b51 3358Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
514b4e19 3359This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3360
3361@kindex --no-seh
3362@item --no-seh
514b4e19 3363@itemx --disable-no-seh
2f563b51 3364The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
514b4e19 3365this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3366
3367@kindex --no-bind
3368@item --no-bind
514b4e19
JD
3369@itemx --disable-no-bind
3370Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3371
3372@kindex --wdmdriver
3373@item --wdmdriver
514b4e19
JD
3374@itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3375The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3376by default.
9d5777a3 3377
2f563b51
DK
3378@kindex --tsaware
3379@item --tsaware
514b4e19
JD
3380@itemx --disable-tsaware
3381The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3382default.
2f563b51 3383
0cb112f7
CF
3384@kindex --insert-timestamp
3385@item --insert-timestamp
eeb14e5a
LZ
3386@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3387Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3388as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3389other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
56e6cf80 3390will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
eeb14e5a
LZ
3391same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3392can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
56e6cf80 3393that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
eeb14e5a 3394identically.
dc9bd8c9
HD
3395
3396@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3397@item --enable-reloc-section
514b4e19 3398@itemx --disable-reloc-section
dc9bd8c9
HD
3399Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3400is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
514b4e19 3401This option is enabled by default.
252b5132
RH
3402@end table
3403
0285c67d
NC
3404@c man end
3405
ac145307
BS
3406@ifset C6X
3407@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3408
3409@c man begin OPTIONS
3410
3411The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3412libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3413all executables use an index of 0.
3414
3415@table @gcctabopt
3416
3417@kindex --dsbt-size
3418@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
56e6cf80 3419This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
ac145307
BS
3420or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3421entries.
3422
3423@kindex --dsbt-index
3424@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3425This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3426to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3427executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3428@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3429
fbd9ad90
PB
3430@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3431The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3432exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3433
ac145307
BS
3434@end table
3435
3436@c man end
3437@end ifset
3438
b8891f8d
AJ
3439@ifset CSKY
3440@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3441
3442@c man begin OPTIONS
3443
3444@table @gcctabopt
3445
3446@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3447@item --branch-stub
3448This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3449sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3450usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3451can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3452the compiler or assembler.
3453
3454@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3455@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3456This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3457It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3458be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3459stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3460sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3461@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3462linker should choose suitable defaults.
3463
3464@end table
3465
3466@c man end
3467@end ifset
3468
93fd0973
SC
3469@ifset M68HC11
3470@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3471
3472@c man begin OPTIONS
3473
3474The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3475memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3476
3477@table @gcctabopt
3478
3479@kindex --no-trampoline
3480@item --no-trampoline
3481This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3482is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3483instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3484
3485@kindex --bank-window
3486@item --bank-window @var{name}
3487This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3488the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3489The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3490paging and addresses within the memory window.
3491
3492@end table
3493
3494@c man end
3495@end ifset
3496
7fb9f789
NC
3497@ifset M68K
3498@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3499
3500@c man begin OPTIONS
3501
3502The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3503when linking for 68K targets.
3504
3505@table @gcctabopt
3506
3507@kindex --got
3508@item --got=@var{type}
3509This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3510@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3511@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3512Info entry for @file{ld}.
3513
3514@end table
3515
3516@c man end
3517@end ifset
3518
833794fc
MR
3519@ifset MIPS
3520@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3521
3522@c man begin OPTIONS
3523
3524The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
8b10b0b3
MR
3525generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3526linking for MIPS targets.
833794fc
MR
3527
3528@table @gcctabopt
3529
3530@kindex --insn32
3531@item --insn32
3532@kindex --no-insn32
3533@itemx --no-insn32
3534These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3535generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3536or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
353732-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3538used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3539possible.
3540
8b10b0b3
MR
3541@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3542@item --ignore-branch-isa
3543@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3544@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3545These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3546transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3547accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3548is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3549instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3550equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3551calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3552a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3553an error.
3554
3734320d
MF
3555@kindex --compact-branches
3556@item --compact-branches
3557@kindex --no-compact-branches
fa1477dc 3558@itemx --no-compact-branches
3734320d
MF
3559These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3560in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3561
833794fc
MR
3562@end table
3563
3564@c man end
3565@end ifset
3566
fa1477dc
SC
3567
3568@ifset PDP11
3569@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3570
3571@c man begin OPTIONS
3572
3573For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3574produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3575for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3576targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3577defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3578here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3579
3580@table @gcctabopt
3581
3582@kindex -N
3583@item -N
3584@kindex --omagic
3585@itemx --omagic
3586
3587Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3588indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3589shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3590writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3591the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3592programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3593from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3594
3595@kindex -n
3596@item -n
3597@kindex --nmagic
3598@itemx --nmagic
3599
3600Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3601indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3602be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3603file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3604byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3605a @emph{pure executable} format.
3606
3607@kindex -z
3608@item -z
3609@kindex --imagic
3610@itemx --imagic
3611
3612Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3613indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3614data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3615instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3616larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3617to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3618shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3619option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3620and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3621this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3622executable} format.
3623
3624@kindex --no-omagic
3625@item --no-omagic
3626
3627Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3628
3629@end table
3630
3631@c man end
3632@end ifset
3633
252b5132
RH
3634@ifset UsesEnvVars
3635@node Environment
3636@section Environment Variables
3637
0285c67d
NC
3638@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3639
560e09e9 3640You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
36f63dca
NC
3641@ifclear SingleFormat
3642@code{GNUTARGET},
3643@end ifclear
3644@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
252b5132 3645
36f63dca 3646@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
3647@kindex GNUTARGET
3648@cindex default input format
3649@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3650use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3651of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
ff5dcc92 3652@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
252b5132
RH
3653of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3654attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3655this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3656there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3657object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3658BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3659in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
36f63dca 3660@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
3661
3662@kindex LDEMULATION
3663@cindex default emulation
3664@cindex emulation, default
3665@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3666@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3667behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3668available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3669the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3670variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3671linker was configured.
252b5132
RH
3672
3673@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3674@cindex demangling, default
3675Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3676@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3677default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3678a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3679may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3680options.
3681
0285c67d
NC
3682@c man end
3683@end ifset
3684
252b5132
RH
3685@node Scripts
3686@chapter Linker Scripts
3687
3688@cindex scripts
3689@cindex linker scripts
3690@cindex command files
3691Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3692written in the linker command language.
3693
3694The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3695the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3696the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3697more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3698direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3699described below.
3700
3701The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3702yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
a05a5b64
TP
3703linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3704to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
252b5132
RH
3705such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3706
3707You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3708line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3709default linker script.
3710
3711You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3712to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3713Linker Scripts}.
3714
3715@menu
3716* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3717* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3718* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3719* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3720* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3721* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3722* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3723* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3724* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3725* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3726* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3727@end menu
3728
3729@node Basic Script Concepts
3730@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3731@cindex linker script concepts
3732We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3733describe the linker script language.
3734
3735The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3736file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3737@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3738The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3739purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3740among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3741section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3742in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3743
3744Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3745also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
56dd11f0 3746contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
252b5132
RH
3747the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3748A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3749area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3750loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3751which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3752of debugging information.
3753
3754Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3755first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3756the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3757@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3758section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3759same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3760is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3761(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3762based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3763RAM address would be the VMA.
3764
3765You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3766program with the @samp{-h} option.
3767
3768Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3769@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3770has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3771information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3772will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3773static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3774referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3775
3776You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3777program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3778option.
3779
3780@node Script Format
3781@section Linker Script Format
3782@cindex linker script format
3783Linker scripts are text files.
3784
3785You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3786either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3787symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3788generally ignored.
3789
3790Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3791If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3792otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3793double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3794file name.
3795
3796You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3797@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3798to whitespace.
3799
3800@node Simple Example
3801@section Simple Linker Script Example
3802@cindex linker script example
3803@cindex example of linker script
3804Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3805
3806The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3807@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3808memory layout of the output file.
3809
3810The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3811describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3812code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3813@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3814Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3815your input files.
3816
3817For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
38180x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3819linker script which will do that:
3820@smallexample
3821SECTIONS
3822@{
3823 . = 0x10000;
3824 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3825 . = 0x8000000;
3826 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3827 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3828@}
3829@end smallexample
3830
3831You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3832followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3833descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3834
252b5132
RH
3835The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3836sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3837counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3838other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3839current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3840incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3841@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3842
3843The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3844required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3845after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3846which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3847wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3848means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3849
3850Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3851@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3852@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3853
3854The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3855the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3856at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3857output section, the value of the location counter will be
3858@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3859effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
58434bc1 3860immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
252b5132
RH
3861
3862The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3863alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3864example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3865sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3866may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3867sections.
3868
3869That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3870
3871@node Simple Commands
3872@section Simple Linker Script Commands
3873@cindex linker script simple commands
3874In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3875
3876@menu
3877* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3878* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3879@ifclear SingleFormat
3880* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3881@end ifclear
3882
4a93e180 3883* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
252b5132
RH
3884* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3885@end menu
3886
3887@node Entry Point
36f63dca 3888@subsection Setting the Entry Point
252b5132
RH
3889@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3890@cindex start of execution
3891@cindex first instruction
3892@cindex entry point
3893The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3894point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3895entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3896@smallexample
3897ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3898@end smallexample
3899
3900There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3901entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3902stopping when one of them succeeds:
3903@itemize @bullet
a1ab1d2a 3904@item
252b5132 3905the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
a1ab1d2a 3906@item
252b5132 3907the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
a1ab1d2a 3908@item
a094d01f 3909the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
8a758655 3910targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3ab904c4 3911check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
a1ab1d2a 3912@item
5226a6a8
NC
3913the address of the first byte of the code section, if present and an
3914executable is being created - the code section is usually
3915@samp{.text}, but can be something else;
a1ab1d2a 3916@item
252b5132
RH
3917The address @code{0}.
3918@end itemize
3919
3920@node File Commands
36f63dca 3921@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
252b5132
RH
3922@cindex linker script file commands
3923Several linker script commands deal with files.
3924
3925@table @code
3926@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3927@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3928@cindex including a linker script
3929Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3930be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
ff5dcc92 3931with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
252b5132
RH
393210 levels deep.
3933
4006703d
NS
3934You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3935@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3936
252b5132
RH
3937@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3938@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3939@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3940@cindex input files in linker scripts
3941@cindex input object files in linker scripts
3942@cindex linker script input object files
3943The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3944in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3945
3946For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
3947a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
3948then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
3949
3950In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
3951script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
3952
e3f2db7f
AO
3953In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
3954with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
3955located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
16171946
FS
3956for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
3957@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
3958filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
3959@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3960
3961If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
3962the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
3963found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
3964not found the linker will search through the archive library search
3965path.
252b5132 3966
ff5dcc92 3967If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
a05a5b64 3968name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
252b5132
RH
3969@samp{-l}.
3970
3971When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
3972files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
3973script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
3974
3975@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3976@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3977@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
3978@cindex grouping input files
3979The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
3980files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
3981new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
a05a5b64 3982in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
252b5132 3983
b717d30e
JJ
3984@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3985@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3986@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
3987This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
3988commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
3989as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
3990with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
3991when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
3992@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
3993and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
3994setting afterwards.
3995
252b5132
RH
3996@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3997@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
b45619c0 3998@cindex output file name in linker script
252b5132
RH
3999The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
4000@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
4001@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
a05a5b64 4002Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
252b5132
RH
4003precedence.
4004
4005You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
4006output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
4007
4008@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4009@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4010@cindex library search path in linker script
4011@cindex archive search path in linker script
4012@cindex search path in linker script
4013The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
ff5dcc92 4014@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
252b5132 4015@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
a05a5b64 4016on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
252b5132 4017are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
a05a5b64 4018the command-line option are searched first.
252b5132
RH
4019
4020@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
4021@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
4022@cindex first input file
4023The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
4024that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
4025though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
4026when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
4027first file.
4028@end table
4029
4030@ifclear SingleFormat
4031@node Format Commands
36f63dca 4032@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
252b5132
RH
4033A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
4034
4035@table @code
4036@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4037@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
4038@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4039@cindex output file format in linker script
4040The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
4041output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
024531e2 4042exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4043(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
252b5132
RH
4044line option takes precedence.
4045
4046You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
a05a5b64 4047formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
252b5132
RH
4048This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
4049desired endianness.
4050
4051If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4052will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4053output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
4054used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4055
4056For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4057command:
4058@smallexample
4059OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4060@end smallexample
4061This says that the default format for the output file is
a05a5b64 4062@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
252b5132
RH
4063option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4064format.
4065
4066@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4067@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4068@cindex input file format in linker script
4069The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4070files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4071This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4072(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
252b5132
RH
4073is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4074command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4075@end table
4076@end ifclear
4077
4a93e180
NC
4078@node REGION_ALIAS
4079@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4080@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4081@cindex region alias
4082@cindex region names
4083
4084Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4085@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4086
4087@smallexample
4088REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4089@end smallexample
4090
4091The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4092memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4093to memory regions. An example follows.
4094
4095Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4096memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4097that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4098non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4099access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4100read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4101sections:
4102
4103@itemize @bullet
4104@item
4105@code{.text} program code;
4106@item
4107@code{.rodata} read-only data;
4108@item
4109@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4110@item
4111@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4112@end itemize
4113
4114The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4115part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4116output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4117systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4118@code{C}:
4119@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4120@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
9d5777a3 4121@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4a93e180
NC
4122@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4123@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4124@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4125@end multitable
4126The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4127loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4128the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4129the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4130
4131The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4132includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4133memory layout:
4134@smallexample
4135INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4136
4137SECTIONS
4138 @{
4139 .text :
4140 @{
4141 *(.text)
4142 @} > REGION_TEXT
4143 .rodata :
4144 @{
4145 *(.rodata)
4146 rodata_end = .;
4147 @} > REGION_RODATA
4148 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4149 @{
4150 data_start = .;
4151 *(.data)
4152 @} > REGION_DATA
4153 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4154 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4155 .bss :
4156 @{
4157 *(.bss)
4158 @} > REGION_BSS
4159 @}
4160@end smallexample
4161
4162Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4163regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4164variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4165@table @code
4166@item A
4167Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4168@smallexample
4169MEMORY
4170 @{
4171 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4172 @}
4173
4174REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4175REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4176REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4177REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4178@end smallexample
4179@item B
4180Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4181into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4182@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4183@smallexample
4184MEMORY
4185 @{
4186 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4187 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4188 @}
4189
4190REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4191REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4192REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4193REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4194@end smallexample
4195@item C
4196Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4197@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4198initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4199system start into the @code{RAM}.
4200@smallexample
4201MEMORY
4202 @{
4203 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4204 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4205 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4206 @}
4207
4208REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4209REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4210REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4211REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4212@end smallexample
4213@end table
4214
4215It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4216@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4217necessary:
4218@smallexample
4219#include <string.h>
4220
4221extern char data_start [];
4222extern char data_size [];
4223extern char data_load_start [];
4224
4225void copy_data(void)
4226@{
4227 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4228 @{
4229 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4230 @}
4231@}
4232@end smallexample
4233
252b5132 4234@node Miscellaneous Commands
36f63dca 4235@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
252b5132
RH
4236There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4237
4238@table @code
4239@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4240@kindex ASSERT
4241@cindex assertion in linker script
4242Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4243with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4244
fd1c4238
NC
4245Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4246take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4247inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4248for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4249symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4250
4251@smallexample
4252 .stack :
4253 @{
4254 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4255 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4256 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4257 @}
4258@end smallexample
4259
4260will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4261PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4262can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4263
4264@smallexample
4265 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4266 .stack :
4267 @{
4268 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4269 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4270 @}
4271@end smallexample
4272
4273will work.
4274
252b5132
RH
4275@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4276@kindex EXTERN
4277@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4278Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4279symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4280modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4281each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4282command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4283
4284@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4285@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4286@cindex common allocation in linker script
4287This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
ff5dcc92 4288to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
252b5132
RH
4289output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4290
4818e05f
AM
4291@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4292@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4293@cindex common allocation in linker script
4294This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4295command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4296to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4297
7bdf4127
AB
4298@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4299@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4300@cindex group allocation in linker script
4301@cindex section groups
4302@cindex COMDAT
4303This command has the same effect as the
4304@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4305@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4306and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4307specified (@samp{-r}).
4308
53d25da6
AM
4309@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4310@kindex INSERT
4311@cindex insert user script into default script
4312This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4313augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4314inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4315@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4316default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4317sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4318linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4319insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4320linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4321default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4322of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4323to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4324is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4325
4326@smallexample
4327SECTIONS
4328@{
4329 OVERLAY :
4330 @{
4331 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4332 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4333 @}
4334@}
4335INSERT AFTER .text;
4336@end smallexample
4337
252b5132
RH
4338@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4339@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4340@cindex cross references
ff5dcc92 4341This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
252b5132
RH
4342references among certain output sections.
4343
4344In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4345using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4346will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4347errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4348a function defined in the other section.
4349
4350The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
ff5dcc92 4351@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
252b5132
RH
4352an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4353@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4354names.
4355
cdf96953
MF
4356@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4357@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4358@cindex cross references
4359This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4360references to one section from a list of other sections.
4361
4362The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4363output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4364a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4365there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4366must never call back.
4367
4368The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4369The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4370If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4371the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4372status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4373names, not input section names.
4374
252b5132
RH
4375@ifclear SingleFormat
4376@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4377@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4378@cindex machine architecture
4379@cindex architecture
4380Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4381of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4382architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4383the @samp{-f} option.
4384@end ifclear
01554a74
AM
4385
4386@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4387@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4388This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4389@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4390in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4391@xref{Expression Section}.
252b5132
RH
4392@end table
4393
4394@node Assignments
4395@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4396@cindex assignment in scripts
4397@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4398@cindex variables, defining
4399You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
73ae6183 4400the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
252b5132
RH
4401
4402@menu
4403* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
eb8476a6 4404* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
252b5132 4405* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
7af8e998 4406* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
73ae6183 4407* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
252b5132
RH
4408@end menu
4409
4410@node Simple Assignments
4411@subsection Simple Assignments
4412
4413You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4414
4415@table @code
4416@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4417@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4418@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4419@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4420@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4421@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4422@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4423@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4424@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4425@end table
4426
4427The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4428@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4429defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4430
4431The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
b5666f2f 4432may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
252b5132
RH
4433
4434The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4435
4436Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4437
4438You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4439statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4440section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4441
4442The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4443expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4444
4445Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4446assignments may be used:
4447
4448@smallexample
4449floating_point = 0;
4450SECTIONS
4451@{
4452 .text :
4453 @{
4454 *(.text)
4455 _etext = .;
4456 @}
156e34dd 4457 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
252b5132
RH
4458 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4459@}
4460@end smallexample
4461@noindent
4462In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4463zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4464the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4465defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4466upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4467
eb8476a6
MR
4468@node HIDDEN
4469@subsection HIDDEN
4470@cindex HIDDEN
4471For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4472exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4473
4474Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4475@code{HIDDEN}:
4476
4477@smallexample
4478HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4479SECTIONS
4480@{
4481 .text :
4482 @{
4483 *(.text)
4484 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4485 @}
4486 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4487 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4488@}
4489@end smallexample
4490@noindent
4491In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4492
252b5132
RH
4493@node PROVIDE
4494@subsection PROVIDE
4495@cindex PROVIDE
4496In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4497only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4498the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4499@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4500@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4501@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4502@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4503@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4504
4505Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4506@smallexample
4507SECTIONS
4508@{
4509 .text :
4510 @{
4511 *(.text)
4512 _etext = .;
4513 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4514 @}
4515@}
4516@end smallexample
4517
4518In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
3c27360b
JB
4519underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic. If,
4520on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
252b5132
RH
4521underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4522If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4523linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4524
b0daac83
NC
4525Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4526defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4527that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4528when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4529@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4530
7af8e998
L
4531@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4532@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4533@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4534Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4535hidden and won't be exported.
4536
73ae6183
NC
4537@node Source Code Reference
4538@subsection Source Code Reference
4539
4540Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4541intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4542a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4543symbol that does not have a value.
4544
4545Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4546transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4547stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4548prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4549mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4550of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4551variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4552linker script variable might be referred to as:
4553
4554@smallexample
4555 extern int foo;
4556@end smallexample
4557
4558But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4559
4560@smallexample
4561 _foo = 1000;
4562@end smallexample
4563
4564In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4565transformation has taken place.
4566
4567When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4568things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4569in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4570second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4571table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4572contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4573value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4574
4575@smallexample
4576 int foo = 1000;
4577@end smallexample
4578
10bf6894 4579creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
73ae6183
NC
4580holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4581number 1000 is initially stored.
4582
4583When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4584first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4585memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4586So:
4587
4588@smallexample
4589 foo = 1;
4590@end smallexample
4591
4592looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4593associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4594address. Whereas:
4595
4596@smallexample
4597 int * a = & foo;
4598@end smallexample
4599
10bf6894 4600looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
73ae6183
NC
4601and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4602the variable @samp{a}.
4603
4604Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4605the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4606an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4607
4608@smallexample
4609 foo = 1000;
4610@end smallexample
4611
4612creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4613the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4614address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4615linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4616access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4617
4618Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4619you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4620use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4621section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4622linker script contains these declarations:
4623
4624@smallexample
4625@group
4626 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
a5e406b5 4627 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
73ae6183
NC
4628 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4629@end group
4630@end smallexample
4631
4632Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4633
4634@smallexample
4635@group
4636 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
c0065db7 4637
73ae6183
NC
4638 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4639@end group
4640@end smallexample
4641
4642Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
5707d2ad
NC
4643Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4644arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4645
4646@smallexample
4647@group
4648 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4649
4650 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4651@end group
4652@end smallexample
4653
4654Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4655operators.
73ae6183 4656
252b5132 4657@node SECTIONS
36f63dca 4658@section SECTIONS Command
252b5132
RH
4659@kindex SECTIONS
4660The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4661into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4662
4663The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4664@smallexample
4665SECTIONS
4666@{
4667 @var{sections-command}
4668 @var{sections-command}
4669 @dots{}
4670@}
4671@end smallexample
4672
4673Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4674
4675@itemize @bullet
4676@item
4677an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4678@item
4679a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4680@item
4681an output section description
4682@item
4683an overlay description
4684@end itemize
4685
4686The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4687@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4688those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4689understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4690the layout of the output file.
4691
4692Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4693below.
4694
4695If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4696linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4697section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4698input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4699example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4700in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4701
4702@menu
4703* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4704* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4705* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4706* Input Section:: Input section description
4707* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4708* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4709* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4710* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4711* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4712@end menu
4713
4714@node Output Section Description
36f63dca 4715@subsection Output Section Description
252b5132
RH
4716The full description of an output section looks like this:
4717@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 4718@group
7e7d5768 4719@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 4720 [AT(@var{lma})]
1eec346e 4721 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
4722 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4723 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
4724 @{
4725 @var{output-section-command}
4726 @var{output-section-command}
4727 @dots{}
abc9061b 4728 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
252b5132
RH
4729@end group
4730@end smallexample
4731
4732Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4733
4734The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4735name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
abc9061b
CC
4736The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4737the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
252b5132
RH
4738The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4739
4740Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4741
4742@itemize @bullet
4743@item
4744a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4745@item
4746an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4747@item
4748data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4749@item
4750a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4751@end itemize
4752
4753@node Output Section Name
36f63dca 4754@subsection Output Section Name
252b5132
RH
4755@cindex name, section
4756@cindex section name
4757The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4758meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4759support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4760must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4761example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4762output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4763names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4764quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4765characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4766commas must be quoted.
4767
4768The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4769Discarding}.
4770
4771@node Output Section Address
2a16d82a 4772@subsection Output Section Address
252b5132
RH
4773@cindex address, section
4774@cindex section address
4775The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
ea5cae92
NC
4776address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4777is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4778
4779If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4780section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4781to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4782alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4783contained within the output section.
4784
4785The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4786
4787@itemize @bullet
4788@item
4789If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4790is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4791in that region.
4792
4793@item
4794If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4795regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4796section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4797be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4798
4799@item
4800If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4801the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4802counter.
4803@end itemize
4804
4805@noindent
4806For example:
4807
252b5132
RH
4808@smallexample
4809.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4810@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4811
252b5132
RH
4812@noindent
4813and
ea5cae92 4814
252b5132
RH
4815@smallexample
4816.text : @{ *(.text) @}
4817@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4818
252b5132
RH
4819@noindent
4820are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4821@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4822counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
ea5cae92
NC
4823counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4824input sections.
252b5132
RH
4825
4826The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4827For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4828so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4829do something like this:
4830@smallexample
4831.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4832@end smallexample
4833@noindent
4834This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4835aligned upward to the specified value.
4836
4837Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
6ce340f1
NC
4838location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4839sections are ignored).
252b5132
RH
4840
4841@node Input Section
36f63dca 4842@subsection Input Section Description
252b5132
RH
4843@cindex input sections
4844@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4845The most common output section command is an input section description.
4846
4847The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4848You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4849in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4850map the input files into your memory layout.
4851
4852@menu
4853* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4854* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4855* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4856* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4857* Input Section Example:: Input section example
4858@end menu
4859
4860@node Input Section Basics
36f63dca 4861@subsubsection Input Section Basics
252b5132
RH
4862@cindex input section basics
4863An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4864by a list of section names in parentheses.
4865
4866The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4867describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4868
4869The most common input section description is to include all input
4870sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4871include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4872@smallexample
4873*(.text)
4874@end smallexample
4875@noindent
18625d54 4876Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
8f1732fc 4877@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
18625d54
CM
4878of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4879match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4880example:
252b5132 4881@smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4882EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4883@end smallexample
4884@noindent
4885will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4886and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4887placed inside the section list, for example:
4888@smallexample
b4346c09 4889*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
252b5132 4890@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4891@noindent
4892The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4893two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4894more than one section, as described below.
252b5132
RH
4895
4896There are two ways to include more than one section:
4897@smallexample
4898*(.text .rdata)
4899*(.text) *(.rdata)
4900@end smallexample
4901@noindent
4902The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4903@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
b6bf44ba
AM
4904first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4905they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
252b5132
RH
4906@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4907@samp{.rdata} input sections.
4908
8f1732fc
AB
4909When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4910is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4911immediately following section, for example:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4912@smallexample
4913*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4914@end smallexample
4915@noindent
4916will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4917@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4918from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4919exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
8f1732fc 4920could be modified to:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4921@smallexample
4922*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4923@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4924@noindent
4925Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4926before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4927all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4928@smallexample
4929EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4930@end smallexample
a5bf7d4f 4931
252b5132
RH
4932You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4933You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4934needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4935@smallexample
4936data.o(.data)
4937@end smallexample
4938
ae17ab41
CM
4939To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4940of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4941
4942Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4943
4944@smallexample
4945@group
4946SECTIONS @{
4947 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
4948 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
4949@}
4950@end group
4951@end smallexample
4952
4953In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
4954input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
4955@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
4956@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
4957whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
4958
967928e9
AM
4959You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
4960matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
4961with no whitespace around the colon.
4962
4963@table @samp
4964@item archive:file
4965matches file within archive
4966@item archive:
4967matches the whole archive
4968@item :file
4969matches file but not one in an archive
4970@end table
4971
4972Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
4973wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
4974single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
4975@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
4976within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
4977also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
4978other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
4979from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
4980command.
4981
252b5132
RH
4982If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
4983the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
4984commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
4985@smallexample
4986data.o
4987@end smallexample
4988
967928e9
AM
4989When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
4990and does not contain any wild card
252b5132
RH
4991characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
4992name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
4993did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
4994though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
4995@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
4996the archive search path.
4997
4998@node Input Section Wildcards
36f63dca 4999@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
252b5132
RH
5000@cindex input section wildcards
5001@cindex wildcard file name patterns
5002@cindex file name wildcard patterns
5003@cindex section name wildcard patterns
5004In an input section description, either the file name or the section
5005name or both may be wildcard patterns.
5006
5007The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
5008pattern for the file name.
5009
5010The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
5011
5012@table @samp
5013@item *
5014matches any number of characters
5015@item ?
5016matches any single character
5017@item [@var{chars}]
5018matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
5019character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
5020@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
5021@item \
5022quotes the following character
5023@end table
5024
252b5132
RH
5025File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
5026specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
5027does not search directories to expand wildcards.
5028
5029If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
5030appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
5031will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
5032sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
5033@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
5034@smallexample
5035.data : @{ *(.data) @}
5036.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
5037@end smallexample
5038
bcaa7b3e 5039@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
252b5132
RH
5040Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
5041in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
bcaa7b3e
L
5042this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
5043pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
5044@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
252b5132
RH
5045into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5046
bcaa7b3e 5047@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
9a24a276
AM
5048@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5049@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5050alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
5051alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5052needed.
bcaa7b3e 5053
02ecc8e9 5054@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
9a24a276
AM
5055@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5056@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5057numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5058section name before placing them in the output file. In
5059@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5060the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5061@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
02ecc8e9 5062
bcaa7b3e
L
5063@cindex SORT
5064@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5065
5066When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5067can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5068
5069@enumerate
5070@item
5071@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5072It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5073sections have the same name.
5074@item
5075@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5076It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5077sections have the same alignment.
5078@item
c0065db7 5079@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
bcaa7b3e
L
5080treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5081@item
5082@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5083is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5084@item
5085All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5086@end enumerate
5087
a05a5b64 5088When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
bcaa7b3e 5089section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
a05a5b64 5090takes precedence over the command-line option.
bcaa7b3e
L
5091
5092If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
a05a5b64 5093command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
bcaa7b3e
L
5094treated as nested sorting command.
5095
5096@enumerate
5097@item
5098@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5099@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5100@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5101@item
5102@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5103@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5104@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5105@end enumerate
5106
5107If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
a05a5b64 5108command-line option will be ignored.
bcaa7b3e 5109
eda680f8 5110@cindex SORT_NONE
a05a5b64 5111@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
eda680f8
L
5112section sorting option.
5113
252b5132
RH
5114If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5115@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5116precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5117
5118This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5119files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5120sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5121The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5122with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5123linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5124@smallexample
5125@group
5126SECTIONS @{
5127 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5128 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5129 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5130 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5131@}
5132@end group
5133@end smallexample
5134
5135@node Input Section Common
36f63dca 5136@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
252b5132
RH
5137@cindex common symbol placement
5138@cindex uninitialized data placement
5139A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5140file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5141linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5142named @samp{COMMON}.
5143
5144You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5145other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5146particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5147input files are placed in another section.
5148
5149In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5150@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5151@smallexample
5152.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5153@end smallexample
5154
5155@cindex scommon section
5156@cindex small common symbols
5157Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5158example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5159symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5160different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5161the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5162symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5163to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5164locations.
5165
5166@cindex [COMMON]
5167You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5168notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5169@samp{*(COMMON)}.
5170
5171@node Input Section Keep
36f63dca 5172@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
252b5132
RH
5173@cindex KEEP
5174@cindex garbage collection
5175When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
a1ab1d2a 5176it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
252b5132
RH
5177This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5178with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
bcaa7b3e 5179@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
252b5132
RH
5180
5181@node Input Section Example
36f63dca 5182@subsubsection Input Section Example
252b5132
RH
5183The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5184to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5185start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5186@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5187follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5188@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5189@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5190All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5191files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5192
5193@smallexample
5194@group
5195SECTIONS @{
5196 outputa 0x10000 :
5197 @{
5198 all.o
5199 foo.o (.input1)
5200 @}
36f63dca
NC
5201@end group
5202@group
252b5132
RH
5203 outputb :
5204 @{
5205 foo.o (.input2)
5206 foo1.o (.input1)
5207 @}
36f63dca
NC
5208@end group
5209@group
252b5132
RH
5210 outputc :
5211 @{
5212 *(.input1)
5213 *(.input2)
5214 @}
5215@}
5216@end group
a1ab1d2a 5217@end smallexample
252b5132 5218
cbd0eecf
L
5219If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5220and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5221automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5222__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5223indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5224respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5225C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5226
252b5132 5227@node Output Section Data
36f63dca 5228@subsection Output Section Data
252b5132
RH
5229@cindex data
5230@cindex section data
5231@cindex output section data
5232@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5233@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5234@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5235@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5236@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5237You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5238@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5239an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5240parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5241value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5242counter.
5243
5244The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5245store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5246bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5247stored.
5248
5249For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5250of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5251@smallexample
5252BYTE(1)
5253LONG(addr)
5254@end smallexample
5255
5256When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5257same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5258target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5259@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5260@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5261
5262If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5263which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5264When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5265true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5266endianness of the first input object file.
5267
36f63dca 5268Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
2b5fc1f5
NC
5269between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5270@smallexample
5271SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5272@end smallexample
5273whereas this will work:
5274@smallexample
5275SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5276@end smallexample
5277
252b5132
RH
5278@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5279@cindex holes, filling
5280@cindex unspecified memory
5281You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5282current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5283otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5284gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
a139d329 5285with the value of the expression, repeated as
252b5132
RH
5286necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5287point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5288than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5289different parts of an output section.
5290
5291This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
563e308f 5292value @samp{0x90}:
252b5132 5293@smallexample
563e308f 5294FILL(0x90909090)
252b5132
RH
5295@end smallexample
5296
5297The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
9673c93c 5298section attribute, but it only affects the
252b5132
RH
5299part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5300entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
9673c93c 5301precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
a139d329 5302expression.
252b5132
RH
5303
5304@node Output Section Keywords
36f63dca 5305@subsection Output Section Keywords
252b5132
RH
5306There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5307commands.
5308
5309@table @code
5310@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5311@cindex input filename symbols
5312@cindex filename symbols
5313@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5314The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5315The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5316file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5317the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5318
5319This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5320normally used for any other object file format.
5321
5322@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5323@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5324@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5325@item CONSTRUCTORS
5326When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5327unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5328destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5329arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5330automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5331For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5332linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5333@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5334ignored for other object file formats.
5335
5336The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
7e69709c
AM
5337constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5338Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5339the start and end of the global destructors. The
252b5132
RH
5340first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5341of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5342compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5343formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5344@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5345the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5346destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5347@code{exit}.
5348
5349For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5350arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5351addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5352and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5353linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5354runtime code expects to see.
5355
5356@smallexample
5357 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5358 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5359 *(.ctors)
5360 LONG(0)
5361 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5362 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5363 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5364 *(.dtors)
5365 LONG(0)
5366 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5367@end smallexample
5368
5369If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5370which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5371are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5372are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
bcaa7b3e
L
5373command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5374@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5375@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
252b5132
RH
5376@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5377
5378Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5379and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5380need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5381scripts.
5382
5383@end table
5384
5385@node Output Section Discarding
36f63dca 5386@subsection Output Section Discarding
252b5132
RH
5387@cindex discarding sections
5388@cindex sections, discarding
5389@cindex removing sections
2edab91c
AM
5390The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5391This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5392may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
252b5132 5393@smallexample
49c13adb 5394.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
252b5132
RH
5395@end smallexample
5396@noindent
5397will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
74541ad4
AM
5398@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5399sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
2edab91c
AM
5400space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5401too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5402space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5403@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5404@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5405This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
74541ad4 5406
a0976ea4 5407The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
74541ad4
AM
5408on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5409symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
a0976ea4
AM
5410the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5411section is discarded.
252b5132
RH
5412
5413@cindex /DISCARD/
5414The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5415input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5416section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5417
99fabbc9
JL
5418This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5419@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5420garbage collection.
5421
a2e098c3
NC
5422Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5423discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5424members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5425Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5426
252b5132 5427@node Output Section Attributes
36f63dca 5428@subsection Output Section Attributes
252b5132
RH
5429@cindex output section attributes
5430We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5431like this:
0c71d759 5432
252b5132 5433@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 5434@group
7e7d5768 5435@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 5436 [AT(@var{lma})]
3bbec4bd 5437 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
5438 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5439 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
5440 @{
5441 @var{output-section-command}
5442 @var{output-section-command}
5443 @dots{}
562d3460 5444 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
252b5132
RH
5445@end group
5446@end smallexample
0c71d759 5447
252b5132
RH
5448We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5449@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5450remaining section attributes.
5451
a1ab1d2a 5452@menu
252b5132
RH
5453* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5454* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
bbf115d3 5455* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
7e7d5768 5456* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
0c71d759 5457* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
252b5132
RH
5458* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5459* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5460* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5461@end menu
5462
5463@node Output Section Type
36f63dca 5464@subsubsection Output Section Type
252b5132
RH
5465Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5466parentheses. The following types are defined:
5467
5468@table @code
5469@item NOLOAD
5470The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5471loaded into memory when the program is run.
6b86da53
LB
5472@item READONLY
5473The section should be marked as read-only.
252b5132
RH
5474@item DSECT
5475@itemx COPY
5476@itemx INFO
5477@itemx OVERLAY
5478These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5479rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5480marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5481section when the program is run.
5482@end table
5483
5484@kindex NOLOAD
5485@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5486@cindex loading, preventing
5487The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5488the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5489the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5490@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
2e76e85a 5491need to be loaded when the program is run.
252b5132
RH
5492@smallexample
5493@group
5494SECTIONS @{
5495 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5496 @dots{}
5497@}
5498@end group
5499@end smallexample
5500
5501@node Output Section LMA
36f63dca 5502@subsubsection Output Section LMA
562d3460 5503@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
252b5132
RH
5504@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5505@cindex load address
5506@cindex section load address
5507Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
ea5cae92
NC
5508@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5509@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5510specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5511address is optional.
6bdafbeb 5512
ea5cae92
NC
5513The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5514specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5515takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5516load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5517region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
dc0b6aa0
AM
5518
5519If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
ea5cae92
NC
5520section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5521load address:
5522
5523@itemize @bullet
5524@item
5525If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5526the LMA address as well.
5527
5528@item
5529If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5530
5531@item
5532Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5533with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5534section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5535VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5536the last section in the located region.
5537
5538@item
5539If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5540that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5541
5542@item
5543If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5544section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5545@end itemize
252b5132
RH
5546
5547@cindex ROM initialized data
5548@cindex initialized data in ROM
5549This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5550example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5551called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5552@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5553even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5554uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5555defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5556counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5557
5558@smallexample
5559@group
5560SECTIONS
5561 @{
5562 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
a1ab1d2a 5563 .mdata 0x2000 :
252b5132
RH
5564 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5565 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5566 .bss 0x3000 :
5567 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5568@}
5569@end group
5570@end smallexample
5571
5572The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5573this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5574the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5575how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5576script.
5577
5578@smallexample
5579@group
5580extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5581char *src = &_etext;
5582char *dst = &_data;
5583
ea5cae92
NC
5584/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5585while (dst < &_edata)
252b5132 5586 *dst++ = *src++;
252b5132 5587
ea5cae92 5588/* Zero bss. */
252b5132
RH
5589for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5590 *dst = 0;
5591@end group
5592@end smallexample
5593
bbf115d3
L
5594@node Forced Output Alignment
5595@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5596@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5597@cindex forcing output section alignment
5598@cindex output section alignment
1eec346e 5599You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
13075d04
SH
5600alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5601intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
bbf115d3 5602
7e7d5768
AM
5603@node Forced Input Alignment
5604@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5605@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5606@cindex forcing input section alignment
5607@cindex input section alignment
5608You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5609SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5610sections, whether larger or smaller.
5611
0c71d759
NC
5612@node Output Section Constraint
5613@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5614@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5615@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5616@cindex constraints on output sections
5617You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5618of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5619read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5620@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5621
252b5132 5622@node Output Section Region
36f63dca 5623@subsubsection Output Section Region
252b5132
RH
5624@kindex >@var{region}
5625@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5626@cindex memory regions and sections
5627You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5628using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5629
5630Here is a simple example:
5631@smallexample
5632@group
5633MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5634SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5635@end group
5636@end smallexample
5637
5638@node Output Section Phdr
36f63dca 5639@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
252b5132
RH
5640@kindex :@var{phdr}
5641@cindex section, assigning to program header
5642@cindex program headers and sections
5643You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5644using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5645one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5646assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5647@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5648linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5649
5650Here is a simple example:
5651@smallexample
5652@group
5653PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5654SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5655@end group
5656@end smallexample
5657
5658@node Output Section Fill
36f63dca 5659@subsubsection Output Section Fill
252b5132
RH
5660@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5661@cindex section fill pattern
5662@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5663You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5664@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5665(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5666within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
a139d329
AM
5667alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5668necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
9673c93c 5669of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
a139d329
AM
5670an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5671fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
9673c93c 5672other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
a139d329
AM
5673pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5674expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
252b5132
RH
5675
5676You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
9673c93c 5677output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
252b5132
RH
5678
5679Here is a simple example:
5680@smallexample
5681@group
563e308f 5682SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
252b5132
RH
5683@end group
5684@end smallexample
5685
5686@node Overlay Description
36f63dca 5687@subsection Overlay Description
252b5132
RH
5688@kindex OVERLAY
5689@cindex overlays
5690An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5691are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5692the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5693copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5694required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5695can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5696than another.
5697
5698Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5699@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5700output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5701command is as follows:
5702@smallexample
5703@group
5704OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5705 @{
5706 @var{secname1}
5707 @{
5708 @var{output-section-command}
5709 @var{output-section-command}
5710 @dots{}
5711 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5712 @var{secname2}
5713 @{
5714 @var{output-section-command}
5715 @var{output-section-command}
5716 @dots{}
5717 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5718 @dots{}
abc9061b 5719 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
252b5132
RH
5720@end group
5721@end smallexample
5722
5723Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5724section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5725section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
11e7fd74 5726those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
252b5132
RH
5727except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5728sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5729
abc9061b
CC
5730The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5731the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5732
252b5132
RH
5733The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5734addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5735memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5736whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5737and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5738and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5739
56dd11f0
NC
5740If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5741references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5742the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5743sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5744@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
252b5132
RH
5745
5746For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
34711ca3 5747provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
252b5132
RH
5748defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5749@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5750the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5751within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5752symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5753
5754At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5755the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5756
5757Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5758@code{SECTIONS} construct.
5759@smallexample
5760@group
5761 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5762 @{
5763 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5764 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5765 @}
5766@end group
5767@end smallexample
5768@noindent
5769This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5770address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5771@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
34711ca3 5772following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
252b5132
RH
5773@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5774@code{__load_stop_text1}.
5775
5776C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5777like the following.
5778
5779@smallexample
5780@group
5781 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5782 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5783 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5784@end group
5785@end smallexample
5786
5787Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5788everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5789example could have been written identically as follows.
5790
5791@smallexample
5792@group
5793 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5794 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5795 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
252b5132 5796 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5797 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5798 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
252b5132
RH
5799 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5800@end group
5801@end smallexample
5802
5803@node MEMORY
36f63dca 5804@section MEMORY Command
252b5132
RH
5805@kindex MEMORY
5806@cindex memory regions
5807@cindex regions of memory
5808@cindex allocating memory
5809@cindex discontinuous memory
5810The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5811memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5812
5813The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5814memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5815may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5816can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5817set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5818regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5819around to fit into the available regions.
5820
127fcdff
AB
5821A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5822however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5823specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5824@code{MEMORY} is:
252b5132
RH
5825@smallexample
5826@group
a1ab1d2a 5827MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5828 @{
5829 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5830 @dots{}
5831 @}
5832@end group
5833@end smallexample
5834
5835The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5836region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5837Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5838with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
4a93e180
NC
5839must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5840add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
9d5777a3 5841command.
252b5132
RH
5842
5843@cindex memory region attributes
5844The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5845whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5846not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5847@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5848section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5849the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5850them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5851
5852The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5853@table @samp
5854@item R
5855Read-only section
5856@item W
5857Read/write section
5858@item X
5859Executable section
5860@item A
5861Allocatable section
5862@item I
5863Initialized section
5864@item L
5865Same as @samp{I}
5866@item !
c09e9a8c 5867Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
252b5132
RH
5868@end table
5869
81c688d5 5870If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
252b5132 5871@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
81c688d5
NC
5872attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5873unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5874not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5875string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5876or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5877the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
252b5132
RH
5878
5879@kindex ORIGIN =
5880@kindex o =
5881@kindex org =
9cd6d51a
NC
5882The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5883the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5884cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5885abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5886@code{ORG}).
252b5132
RH
5887
5888@kindex LENGTH =
5889@kindex len =
5890@kindex l =
5891The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5892region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
9cd6d51a
NC
5893be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5894@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
252b5132
RH
5895
5896In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5897available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5898and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5899linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5900is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5901or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5902explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5903region.
5904
5905@smallexample
5906@group
a1ab1d2a 5907MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5908 @{
5909 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5910 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5911 @}
5912@end group
5913@end smallexample
5914
5915Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5916specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5917@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5918a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5919output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5920was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5921the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5922output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5923region, the linker will issue an error message.
5924
3ec57632 5925It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
c0065db7 5926expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
3ec57632
NC
5927@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5928
5929@smallexample
5930@group
c0065db7 5931 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
3ec57632
NC
5932@end group
5933@end smallexample
5934
252b5132
RH
5935@node PHDRS
5936@section PHDRS Command
5937@kindex PHDRS
5938@cindex program headers
5939@cindex ELF program headers
5940@cindex program segments
5941@cindex segments, ELF
5942The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
5943@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
5944loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
5945program with the @samp{-p} option.
5946
5947When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
5948reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
5949program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
5950This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
5951interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
5952
5953The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
5954in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
5955precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
5956the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
5957not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
5958
5959The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
5960generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
5961ignore @code{PHDRS}.
5962
5963This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
5964@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
5965
5966@smallexample
5967@group
5968PHDRS
5969@{
5970 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
5971 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
5972@}
5973@end group
5974@end smallexample
5975
5976The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
5977of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
5978header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5979with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5c1a3f0f
NS
5980must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
5981is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
252b5132
RH
5982
5983Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
5984system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
5985specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
5986sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
5987attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
5988Section Phdr}.
5989
5990It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
5991merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
5992repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
5993contain the section.
5994
5995If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
5996then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
5997not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
5998convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
5999placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
6000default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
6001segment at all.
6002
6003@kindex FILEHDR
6004@kindex PHDRS
5c1a3f0f 6005You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
252b5132
RH
6006the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
6007The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
6008file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5c1a3f0f 6009include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
4100cea3
AM
6010segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
6011these keywords.
252b5132
RH
6012
6013The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
6014value of the keyword.
6015
6016@table @asis
6017@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
6018Indicates an unused program header.
6019
6020@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
6021Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
6022the file.
6023
6024@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
6025Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
6026
6027@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
6028Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
6029found.
6030
6031@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
6032Indicates a segment holding note information.
6033
6034@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
6035A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
6036ABI.
6037
6038@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
6039Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
6040
1a9ccd70
NC
6041@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
6042Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
6043
252b5132
RH
6044@item @var{expression}
6045An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
6046be used for types not defined above.
6047@end table
6048
6049You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6050in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
6051@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6052Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6053output section attribute.
6054
6055The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6056which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6057explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
6058an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6059header.
6060
6061Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
6062headers used on a native ELF system.
6063
6064@example
6065@group
6066PHDRS
6067@{
6068 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6069 interp PT_INTERP ;
6070 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6071 data PT_LOAD ;
6072 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6073@}
6074
6075SECTIONS
6076@{
6077 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6078 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6079 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6080 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6081 @dots{}
6082 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6083 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6084 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6085 @dots{}
6086@}
6087@end group
6088@end example
6089
6090@node VERSION
6091@section VERSION Command
6092@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6093@cindex symbol versions
6094@cindex version script
6095@cindex versions of symbols
6096The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6097only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6098symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6099a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6100shared library.
6101
6102You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6103you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6104also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6105
6106The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6107@smallexample
6108VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6109@end smallexample
6110
6111The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6112Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6113version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6114version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6115version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6116scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6117library.
6118
6119The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6120examples.
6121
6122@smallexample
6123VERS_1.1 @{
6124 global:
6125 foo1;
6126 local:
a1ab1d2a
UD
6127 old*;
6128 original*;
6129 new*;
252b5132
RH
6130@};
6131
6132VERS_1.2 @{
6133 foo2;
6134@} VERS_1.1;
6135
6136VERS_2.0 @{
6137 bar1; bar2;
c0065db7 6138 extern "C++" @{
86043bbb 6139 ns::*;
bb1515f2
MF
6140 "f(int, double)";
6141 @};
252b5132
RH
6142@} VERS_1.2;
6143@end smallexample
6144
6145This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6146version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6147The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6148a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
313e35ee
AM
6149of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6150symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6151is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6152in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
86043bbb
MM
6153However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6154name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
252b5132
RH
6155
6156Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6157depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6158to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6159
6160Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6161depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6162and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6163
6164When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6165specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6166unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
a981ed6f 6167unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
ae5a3597
AM
6168somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6169wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6170wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6171set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6172ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
252b5132
RH
6173
6174The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6175they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6176could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6177However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6178
0f6bf451 6179Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6b9b879a
JJ
6180in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6181symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6182won't.
6183
6184@smallexample
7c9c73be 6185@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
9d201f2f 6186@end smallexample
6b9b879a 6187
252b5132
RH
6188When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6189symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6190requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6191shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6192loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6193linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6194application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6195way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6196all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6197search for each symbol reference.
6198
6199The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6200doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6201that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6202functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6203the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6204required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6205that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6206versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6207the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6208
6209There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6210first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6211source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6212script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6213maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6214@smallexample
6215__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6216@end smallexample
6217@noindent
6218in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6219be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6220The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
96a94295
L
6221@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6222takes precedence over a version script.
252b5132
RH
6223
6224The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6225function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6226an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6227version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6228linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6229
6230To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6231source file. Here is an example:
6232
6233@smallexample
6234__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6235__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6236__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6237__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6238@end smallexample
6239
6240In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6241unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6242example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6243@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6244
6245When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6246some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6247this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6248@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6249declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6250you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6251
6252If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6253within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
36f63dca 6254(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
252b5132
RH
6255specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6256
cb840a31
L
6257You can also specify the language in the version script:
6258
6259@smallexample
6260VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6261@end smallexample
6262
c0065db7 6263The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
cb840a31
L
6264The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6265demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
bb1515f2
MF
6266patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6267@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
cb840a31 6268
86043bbb
MM
6269Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6270described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6271or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6272the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6273whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6274cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6275might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6276should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6277expect when you upgrade.
6278
252b5132
RH
6279@node Expressions
6280@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6281@cindex expressions
6282@cindex arithmetic
6283The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
fb0afe4c
AM
6284that of C expressions, except that whitespace is required in some
6285places to resolve syntactic ambiguities. All expressions are
6286evaluated as integers. All expressions are evaluated in the same
6287size, which is 32 bits if both the host and target are 32 bits, and is
6288otherwise 64 bits.
252b5132
RH
6289
6290You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6291
6292The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6293expressions.
6294
6295@menu
6296* Constants:: Constants
0c71d759 6297* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
252b5132 6298* Symbols:: Symbol Names
ecca9871 6299* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
252b5132
RH
6300* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6301* Operators:: Operators
6302* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6303* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6304* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6305@end menu
6306
6307@node Constants
6308@subsection Constants
6309@cindex integer notation
6310@cindex constants in linker scripts
6311All constants are integers.
6312
6313As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6314octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
8a308ae8 6315hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
11e7fd74 6316@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
8a308ae8
NC
6317@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6318value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
252b5132
RH
6319
6320@cindex scaled integers
6321@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6322@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6323@cindex suffixes for integers
6324@cindex integer suffixes
6325In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6326constant by
6327@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6328@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6329@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6330@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6331@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6332@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6333@tex
6334${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6335@end tex
6336@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
8a308ae8
NC
6337respectively. For example, the following
6338all refer to the same quantity:
6339
252b5132 6340@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6341_fourk_1 = 4K;
6342_fourk_2 = 4096;
6343_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
8a308ae8 6344_fourk_4 = 10000o;
252b5132
RH
6345@end smallexample
6346
8a308ae8
NC
6347Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6348conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6349
0c71d759
NC
6350@node Symbolic Constants
6351@subsection Symbolic Constants
6352@cindex symbolic constants
6353@kindex CONSTANT
a094d01f 6354It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
0c71d759
NC
6355the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6356
6357@table @code
6358@item MAXPAGESIZE
6359@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6360The target's maximum page size.
6361
6362@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6363@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6364The target's default page size.
6365@end table
6366
6367So for example:
6368
6369@smallexample
9d5777a3 6370 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
0c71d759
NC
6371@end smallexample
6372
6373will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6374supported by the target.
6375
252b5132
RH
6376@node Symbols
6377@subsection Symbol Names
6378@cindex symbol names
6379@cindex names
6380@cindex quoted symbol names
6381@kindex "
6382Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6383and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6384Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6385specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6386keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6387@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6388"SECTION" = 9;
6389"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
252b5132
RH
6390@end smallexample
6391
6392Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6393to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6394whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6395
ecca9871
L
6396@node Orphan Sections
6397@subsection Orphan Sections
6398@cindex orphan
6399Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6400are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6401script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
a87ded7b
AB
6402output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6403in which to place the orphaned input section.
6404
6405If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6406an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6407placed at the end of that output section.
6408
6409If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6410sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6411name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6412orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6413one new output section.
6414
6415If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6416then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
e299b355
AM
6417in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6418linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6419attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6420sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6421support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
ecca9871 6422
a05a5b64
TP
6423The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6424(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
c005eb9e
AB
6425output sections an orphan is placed in.
6426
252b5132
RH
6427@node Location Counter
6428@subsection The Location Counter
6429@kindex .
6430@cindex dot
6431@cindex location counter
6432@cindex current output location
6433The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6434current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6435location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6436within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6437anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6438
6439@cindex holes
6440Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6441moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
dc0b6aa0
AM
6442location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6443and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6444doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
252b5132
RH
6445
6446@smallexample
6447SECTIONS
6448@{
6449 output :
6450 @{
6451 file1(.text)
6452 . = . + 1000;
6453 file2(.text)
6454 . += 1000;
6455 file3(.text)
563e308f 6456 @} = 0x12345678;
252b5132
RH
6457@}
6458@end smallexample
6459@noindent
6460In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6461located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6462followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6463@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
563e308f 6464@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
252b5132
RH
6465specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6466
5c6bbab8
NC
6467@cindex dot inside sections
6468Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6469current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
69da35b5 6470statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
5c6bbab8
NC
6471absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6472however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6473not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6474
6475@smallexample
6476SECTIONS
6477@{
6478 . = 0x100
6479 .text: @{
6480 *(.text)
6481 . = 0x200
6482 @}
6483 . = 0x500
6484 .data: @{
6485 *(.data)
6486 . += 0x600
6487 @}
6488@}
6489@end smallexample
6490
6491The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6492and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6493the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6494much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6495move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6496and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6497the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6498the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6499
b5666f2f
AM
6500@cindex dot outside sections
6501Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6502output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6503needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6504
6505@smallexample
6506SECTIONS
6507@{
6508 start_of_text = . ;
6509 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6510 end_of_text = . ;
6511
6512 start_of_data = . ;
6513 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6514 end_of_data = . ;
6515@}
6516@end smallexample
6517
6518If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6519not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6520between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6521should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6522blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6523the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6524sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6525statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6526special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6527place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6528as follows:
6529
6530@smallexample
6531SECTIONS
6532@{
6533 start_of_text = . ;
6534 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6535 end_of_text = . ;
6536
6537 start_of_data = . ;
6538 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6539 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6540 end_of_data = . ;
6541@}
6542@end smallexample
6543
6544This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6545@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6546placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6547assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6548a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6549section. So you could write:
6550
6551@smallexample
6552SECTIONS
6553@{
6554 start_of_text = . ;
6555 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6556 end_of_text = . ;
6557
6558 . = . ;
6559 start_of_data = . ;
6560 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6561 end_of_data = . ;
6562@}
6563@end smallexample
6564
6565Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6566@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6567
252b5132
RH
6568@need 2000
6569@node Operators
6570@subsection Operators
6571@cindex operators for arithmetic
6572@cindex arithmetic operators
6573@cindex precedence in expressions
6574The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6575the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6576@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6577@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6578@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6579@smallexample
6580precedence associativity Operators Notes
6581(highest)
65821 left ! - ~ (1)
65832 left * / %
65843 left + -
65854 left >> <<
65865 left == != > < <= >=
65876 left &
65887 left |
65898 left &&
65909 left ||
659110 right ? :
659211 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6593(lowest)
6594@end smallexample
6595Notes:
a1ab1d2a 6596(1) Prefix operators
252b5132
RH
6597(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6598@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6599@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6600@tex
6601\vskip \baselineskip
6602%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6603\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6604\hrule
6605\halign
6606{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6607height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6608&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6609height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6610\noalign{\hrule}
6611height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6612&highest&&&&&\cr
6613% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
a1ab1d2a 6614&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6615&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6616&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6617&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6618&5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6619&6&&left&&\&&\cr
6620&7&&left&&|&\cr
6621&8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6622&9&&left&&||&\cr
6623&10&&right&&? :&\cr
6624&11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6625&lowest&&&&&\cr
6626height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6627\hrule}
6628@end tex
6629@iftex
6630{
6631@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6632@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6633@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6634}
6635@end iftex
6636@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6637
6638@node Evaluation
6639@subsection Evaluation
6640@cindex lazy evaluation
6641@cindex expression evaluation order
6642The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6643an expression when absolutely necessary.
6644
6645The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6646address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6647regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6648as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6649
6650However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6651until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6652other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6653for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6654
6655The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6656assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6657allocation.
6658
6659Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6660@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6661
6662If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6663available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6664following
6665@smallexample
6666@group
6667SECTIONS
6668 @{
a1ab1d2a 6669 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
252b5132
RH
6670 @{ *(.text) @}
6671 @}
6672@end group
6673@end smallexample
6674@noindent
6675will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6676address}.
6677
6678@node Expression Section
6679@subsection The Section of an Expression
6680@cindex expression sections
6681@cindex absolute expressions
6682@cindex relative expressions
6683@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6684@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6685@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7542af2a
AM
6686Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6687relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6688using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6689value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6690symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6691operations.
6692
abf4be64
AM
6693Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6694section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6695address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6696@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6697functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
01554a74
AM
6698One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6699(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
5c3049d2
AM
6700differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6701versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6702section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6703Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
01554a74
AM
6704absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6705given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6706everywhere.
5c3049d2
AM
6707
6708In the following simple example,
252b5132 6709
7542af2a
AM
6710@smallexample
6711@group
6712SECTIONS
6713 @{
6714 . = 0x100;
6715 __executable_start = 0x100;
6716 .data :
6717 @{
6718 . = 0x10;
6719 __data_start = 0x10;
6720 *(.data)
6721 @}
6722 @dots{}
6723 @}
6724@end group
6725@end smallexample
252b5132 6726
7542af2a
AM
6727both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6728address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6729@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6730section in the second two assignments.
252b5132 6731
5c3049d2
AM
6732For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6733addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7542af2a
AM
6734
6735@itemize @bullet
6736@item
c05f749e
AM
6737Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6738operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6739absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6740@item
7542af2a
AM
6741Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6742relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6743and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6744@item
c05f749e
AM
6745Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6746in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6747address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6748before applying the operator.
7542af2a
AM
6749@end itemize
6750
6751The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6752
6753@itemize @bullet
6754@item
6755An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6756@item
6757The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6758@item
9bc8bb33 6759The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
11e7fd74 6760relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
94b41882
AM
6761(after above conversions) is also a number when
6762@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6763but an absolute address otherwise.
9bc8bb33
AM
6764@item
6765The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6766relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6767section as the relative operand(s).
7542af2a
AM
6768@item
6769The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6770conversions) is an absolute address.
6771@end itemize
252b5132
RH
6772
6773You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6774to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6775create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6776section @samp{.data}:
6777@smallexample
6778SECTIONS
6779 @{
6780 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6781 @}
6782@end smallexample
6783@noindent
6784If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6785@samp{.data} section.
6786
7542af2a
AM
6787Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6788particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6789
252b5132
RH
6790@node Builtin Functions
6791@subsection Builtin Functions
6792@cindex functions in expressions
6793The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6794use in linker script expressions.
6795
6796@table @code
6797@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6798@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6799@cindex expression, absolute
6800Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6801of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6802value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6803normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6804
6805@item ADDR(@var{section})
6806@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6807@cindex section address in expression
7542af2a 6808Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
252b5132 6809script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7542af2a
AM
6810the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6811@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6812@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6813the other two will be absolute:
252b5132
RH
6814@smallexample
6815@group
6816SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6817 .output1 :
a1ab1d2a 6818 @{
252b5132
RH
6819 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6820 @dots{}
6821 @}
6822 .output :
6823 @{
6824 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6825 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6826 @}
6827@dots{} @}
6828@end group
6829@end smallexample
6830
876f4090
NS
6831@item ALIGN(@var{align})
6832@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6833@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6834@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
252b5132
RH
6835@cindex round up location counter
6836@cindex align location counter
876f4090
NS
6837@cindex round up expression
6838@cindex align expression
6839Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6840to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6841doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6842arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6843expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
e0a3af22 6844equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
876f4090
NS
6845
6846Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6847next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6848variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6849input sections:
252b5132
RH
6850@smallexample
6851@group
6852SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6853 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6854 *(.data)
6855 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6856 @}
6857@dots{} @}
6858@end group
6859@end smallexample
6860@noindent
6861The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6862a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6863a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6864of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6865
6866The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6867
362c1d1a
NS
6868@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6869@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6870@cindex section alignment
6871Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6872been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6873evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6874the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6875value in that section.
6876@smallexample
6877@group
6878SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6879 .output @{
6880 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6881 @dots{}
6882 @}
6883@dots{} @}
6884@end group
6885@end smallexample
6886
252b5132
RH
6887@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6888@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6889This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6890scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6891section.
6892
2d20f7bf
JJ
6893@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6894@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6895This is equivalent to either
6896@smallexample
6897(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6898@end smallexample
6899or
6900@smallexample
fe6052e1
AM
6901(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6902 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
2d20f7bf
JJ
6903@end smallexample
6904@noindent
6905depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6906for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6907@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6908If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6909memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6910bytes in the on-disk file.
6911
6912This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6913any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6914@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
def5c83c
AM
6915be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6916running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6917that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6918page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
2d20f7bf
JJ
6919
6920@noindent
6921Example:
6922@smallexample
6923 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6924@end smallexample
6925
6926@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6927@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6928This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6929evaluation purposes.
6930
6931@smallexample
6932 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6933@end smallexample
6934
a4f5ad88
JJ
6935@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6936@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6937This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
eec2f3ed 6938@samp{-z relro} option is used.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6939When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
6940does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
def5c83c
AM
6941@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
6942argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
6943script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
eec2f3ed
AM
6944@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
6945padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
6946section alignment.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6947
6948@smallexample
6949 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
6950@end smallexample
6951
252b5132
RH
6952@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6953@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6954@cindex symbol defaults
6955Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
420e579c
HPN
6956defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
6957return 0. You can use this function to provide
252b5132
RH
6958default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
6959shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
6960the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
6961existed, its value is preserved:
6962
6963@smallexample
6964@group
6965SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6966 .text : @{
6967 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
6968 @dots{}
6969 @}
6970 @dots{}
6971@}
6972@end group
6973@end smallexample
6974
3ec57632
NC
6975@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
6976@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
6977Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6978
252b5132
RH
6979@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
6980@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
6981@cindex section load address in expression
7542af2a 6982Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
252b5132
RH
6983Section LMA}).
6984
2e53f7d6
NC
6985@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6986@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6987Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
6988@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
6989
252b5132
RH
6990@kindex MAX
6991@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6992Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6993
6994@kindex MIN
6995@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6996Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6997
6998@item NEXT(@var{exp})
6999@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
7000@cindex unallocated address, next
7001Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
7002This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
7003use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
7004output file, the two functions are equivalent.
7005
3ec57632
NC
7006@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7007@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7008Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7009
ba916c8a
MM
7010@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7011@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7012Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
c5da8c7d
NC
7013value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
7014@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
7015will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
7016can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7542af2a 7017``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
ba916c8a
MM
7018name.
7019
252b5132
RH
7020@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
7021@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
7022@cindex section size
7023Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
7024been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
7025evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
7026@code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
7027@smallexample
7028@group
7029SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7030 .output @{
7031 .start = . ;
7032 @dots{}
7033 .end = . ;
7034 @}
7035 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
7036 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
7037@dots{} @}
7038@end group
7039@end smallexample
7040
7041@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
252b5132
RH
7042@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
7043@cindex header size
7044Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
7045information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
7046this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
7047choose, to facilitate paging.
7048
7049@cindex not enough room for program headers
7050@cindex program headers, not enough room
7051When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7052@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7053number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7054addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
7055additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7056room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7057the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7058script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7059you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7060command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7061@end table
7062
7063@node Implicit Linker Scripts
7064@section Implicit Linker Scripts
7065@cindex implicit linker scripts
7066If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7067an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7068linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7069linker will report an error.
7070
7071An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7072
7073Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7074assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7075commands.
7076
7077Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7078at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7079read. This can affect archive searching.
7080
bf6d8037
HC
7081@node Plugins
7082@chapter Linker Plugins
7083
7084@cindex plugins
7085@cindex linker plugins
7086The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7087For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7088support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7089
7090Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7091be added here later.
7092
7093@menu
7094* libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7095@end menu
7096
7097@node libdep Plugin
7098@section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7099@cindex static library dependencies
7100Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7101just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7102optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7103within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7104rose to ascendance.
7105
7106One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7107multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7108dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7109library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7110referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7111link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7112libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7113explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7114
7115The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7116to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7117plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7118dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7119and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7120command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7121utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7122being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7123archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7124
7125For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7126library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7127the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7128
7129@smallexample
7130-L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7131@end smallexample
7132
252b5132
RH
7133@ifset GENERIC
7134@node Machine Dependent
7135@chapter Machine Dependent Features
7136
7137@cindex machine dependencies
ff5dcc92
SC
7138@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7139sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
252b5132
RH
7140functionality are not listed.
7141
7142@menu
36f63dca
NC
7143@ifset H8300
7144* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7145@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
7146@ifset M68HC11
7147* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7148@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
7149@ifset ARM
7150* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7151@end ifset
7152@ifset HPPA
7153* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7154@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
7155@ifset M68K
7156* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7157@end ifset
833794fc
MR
7158@ifset MIPS
7159* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7160@end ifset
3c3bdf30 7161@ifset MMIX
36f63dca 7162* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
3c3bdf30 7163@end ifset
2469cfa2 7164@ifset MSP430
36f63dca 7165* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
2469cfa2 7166@end ifset
35c08157
KLC
7167@ifset NDS32
7168* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7169@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
7170@ifset NIOSII
7171* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7172@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
7173@ifset POWERPC
7174* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7175@end ifset
7176@ifset POWERPC64
7177* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7178@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
7179@ifset S/390
7180* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7181@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
7182@ifset SPU
7183* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7184@end ifset
74459f0e 7185@ifset TICOFF
ff5dcc92 7186* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
74459f0e 7187@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
7188@ifset WIN32
7189* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7190@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
7191@ifset XTENSA
7192* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7193@end ifset
252b5132
RH
7194@end menu
7195@end ifset
7196
252b5132
RH
7197@ifset H8300
7198@ifclear GENERIC
7199@raisesections
7200@end ifclear
7201
7202@node H8/300
ff5dcc92 7203@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
252b5132
RH
7204
7205@cindex H8/300 support
ff5dcc92 7206For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
252b5132
RH
7207you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7208
7209@table @emph
7210@cindex relaxing on H8/300
7211@item relaxing address modes
ff5dcc92 7212@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
252b5132
RH
7213targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7214program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7215respectively.
7216
7217@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7218@item synthesizing instructions
81f5558e 7219@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
ff5dcc92 7220@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
252b5132
RH
7221sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7222page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7223(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7224@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7225top page of memory).
1502569c 7226
81f5558e
NC
7227@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7228indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7229displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7230the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7231@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7232whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7233range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7234
1502569c 7235@item bit manipulation instructions
c0065db7 7236@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
1502569c 7237biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
c0065db7 7238which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
1502569c
NC
7239page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7240(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
c0065db7 7241@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c
NC
7242the top page of memory).
7243
7244@item system control instructions
c0065db7
RM
7245@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
724632 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
1502569c
NC
7247changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7248(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
c0065db7 7249@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c 7250the top page of memory).
252b5132
RH
7251@end table
7252
7253@ifclear GENERIC
7254@lowersections
7255@end ifclear
7256@end ifset
7257
36f63dca 7258@ifclear GENERIC
c2dcd04e 7259@ifset Renesas
36f63dca 7260@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
c2dcd04e
NC
7261@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7262@node Renesas
7263@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
36f63dca 7264
c2dcd04e
NC
7265@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7266H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7267options are required for these chips.
36f63dca
NC
7268@end ifset
7269@end ifclear
7270
36f63dca
NC
7271@ifset ARM
7272@ifclear GENERIC
7273@raisesections
7274@end ifclear
7275
93fd0973
SC
7276@ifset M68HC11
7277@ifclear GENERIC
7278@raisesections
7279@end ifclear
7280
7281@node M68HC11/68HC12
7282@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7283
7284@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7285
7286@subsection Linker Relaxation
7287
7288For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7289optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7290
7291@table @emph
7292@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7293@item relaxing address modes
7294@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7295targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7296program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7297respectively.
7298
7299@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7300transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7301page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7302
7303@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7304When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7305of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7306addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7307@code{bset} instructions.
7308
7309@end table
7310
7311@subsection Trampoline Generation
7312
7313@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7314@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7315For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7316call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
c0065db7 7317will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
93fd0973
SC
7318trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7319case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7320point to the function trampoline.
7321
7322@ifclear GENERIC
7323@lowersections
7324@end ifclear
7325@end ifset
7326
36f63dca 7327@node ARM
3674e28a 7328@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
36f63dca
NC
7329
7330@cindex ARM interworking support
7331@kindex --support-old-code
7332For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
b45619c0 7333between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
36f63dca
NC
7334been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7335line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7336libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
a05a5b64 7337option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
36f63dca
NC
7338given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7339which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7340the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7341non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7342
7343@cindex thumb entry point
7344@cindex entry point, thumb
7345@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7346The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7347@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7348But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7349branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7350executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7351
ce11ba6c
KT
7352@cindex PE import table prefixing
7353@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7354The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7355the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
11e7fd74 7356element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
ce11ba6c
KT
7357import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7358
e489d0ae
PB
7359@cindex BE8
7360@kindex --be8
7361The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
080bb7bb
NC
7362executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7363objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7364option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7365little-endian code.
e489d0ae 7366
3674e28a
PB
7367@cindex TARGET1
7368@kindex --target1-rel
7369@kindex --target1-abs
7370The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7371@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7372or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7373and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7374
7375@cindex TARGET2
7376@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7377The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7378@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7379meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7380@table @samp
7381@item rel
eeac373a
PB
7382@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7383@item abs
a57d1773 7384@samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
3674e28a
PB
7385@item got-rel
7386@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7387@end table
7388
319850b4
JB
7389@cindex FIX_V4BX
7390@kindex --fix-v4bx
7391The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7392specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7393interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7394also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7395
7396In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7397linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7398@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7399
7400In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7401relocations are ignored.
7402
845b51d6
PB
7403@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7404@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7405Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7406relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7407
7408@smallexample
7409TST rM, #1
7410MOVEQ PC, rM
7411BX Rn
7412@end smallexample
7413
7414This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7415and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
11e7fd74 7416condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
845b51d6 7417
33bfe774
JB
7418@cindex USE_BLX
7419@kindex --use-blx
7420The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7421BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7422situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7423code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7424each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7425
c6dd86c6
JB
7426@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7427@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7428The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7429bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7430instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7431to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7432the support code can read the intended values.
7433
7434The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7435intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7436and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7437intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7438full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7439you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7440
7441If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7442enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7443@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7444mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7445vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7446@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7447
7448If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7449potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7450such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7451first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7452instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7453the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7454are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7455
2de70689
MGD
7456@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7457@kindex --fix-arm1176
7458@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
9d5777a3
RM
7459The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7460in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7461are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
2de70689
MGD
7462unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7463
9d5777a3 7464Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
11e7fd74 7465Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
2de70689
MGD
7466http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7467
a504d23a
LA
7468@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7469@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7470
7471The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7472workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7473the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7474off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7475the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7476core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7477integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7478VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7479
7480The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7481necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7482
7483The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7484@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7485STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7486linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7487@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7488
7489If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7490potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7491such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7492replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7493branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7494then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7495
7496The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7497the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7498
7499The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7500they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7501there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7502occurs.
7503
7504The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7505PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7506large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7507cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7508occurs.
7509
bf21ed78
MS
7510@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7511@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
726150b7 7512The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
bf21ed78
MS
7513warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7514enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7515linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7516using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7517not be diagnosed.
a9dc9481
JM
7518
7519@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7520@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7521The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7522warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7523@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7524linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7525using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
bf21ed78 7526
726150b7
NC
7527@cindex PIC_VENEER
7528@kindex --pic-veneer
7529The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7530ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7531is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7532@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7533
7534@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7535@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7536The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7537code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7538perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7539placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
a05a5b64 7540controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
726150b7 7541The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
11e7fd74 7542duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
726150b7
NC
7543group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7544code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7545where they should be placed.
7546
7547The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7548@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
07d72278 7549placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
726150b7
NC
7550branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7551placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7552value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7553exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7554A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7555linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7556from the input sections.
7557
7558The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7559@samp{N = +1}.
7560
1a51c1a4
NC
7561Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7562only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7563otherwise.
7564
1db37fe6
YG
7565@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7566@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7567@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7568The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7569
7570The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7571
68fcca92
JW
7572@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7573@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7574@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7575The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7576
7577Please contact ARM for further details.
7578
1db37fe6
YG
7579@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7580@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7581@cindex Merging exidx entries
7582The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7583
7584@kindex --long-plt
7585@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7586The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7587which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7588entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7589
1f56df9d
JW
7590@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7591@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7592The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7593link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7594
4ba2ef8f
TP
7595@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7596All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
a05a5b64 7597Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
4ba2ef8f
TP
7598@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7599veneers in memory.
7600
54ddd295
TP
7601@kindex --cmse-implib
7602@cindex Secure gateway import library
7603The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7604specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7605secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7606executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7607
0955507f
TP
7608@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7609@cindex Input import library
7610The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7611must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7612given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7613in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7614@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7615library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7616library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7617for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7618specified.
7619
36f63dca
NC
7620@ifclear GENERIC
7621@lowersections
7622@end ifclear
7623@end ifset
7624
7625@ifset HPPA
7626@ifclear GENERIC
7627@raisesections
7628@end ifclear
7629
7630@node HPPA ELF32
7631@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7632@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7633@kindex --multi-subspace
7634When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7635import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7636The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7637stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7638multiple sub-spaces.
7639
7640@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7641@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7642Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7643stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7644@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7645sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7646a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7647the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7648conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7649prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7650A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7651branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7652@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7653@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7654detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7655positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7656
7657Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7658single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7659create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7660large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7661
7662@ifclear GENERIC
7663@lowersections
7664@end ifclear
7665@end ifset
7666
7fb9f789
NC
7667@ifset M68K
7668@ifclear GENERIC
7669@raisesections
7670@end ifclear
7671
7672@node M68K
7673@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7674
7675@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7676@kindex --got=@var{type}
7677The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7678The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7679@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7680the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7681@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7682entries only at non-negative offsets.
7683@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7684entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7685support such GOTs.
7686@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7687output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7688file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7689files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7690
7691@ifclear GENERIC
7692@lowersections
7693@end ifclear
7694@end ifset
7695
833794fc
MR
7696@ifset MIPS
7697@ifclear GENERIC
7698@raisesections
7699@end ifclear
7700
7701@node MIPS
7702@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7703
7704@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7705@kindex --insn32
7706@kindex --no-insn32
7707The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7708microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7709in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7710used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7711or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7712including 16-bit ones where possible.
7713
8b10b0b3
MR
7714@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7715@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7716@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7717The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7718control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7719@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7720relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7721calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7722relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7723instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7724or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7725the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7726
833794fc
MR
7727@ifclear GENERIC
7728@lowersections
7729@end ifclear
7730@end ifset
7731
36f63dca
NC
7732@ifset MMIX
7733@ifclear GENERIC
7734@raisesections
7735@end ifclear
7736
7737@node MMIX
7738@section @code{ld} and MMIX
7739For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7740@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7741understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7742can translate between the two formats.
7743
7744There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7745Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7746registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7747equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7748@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7749global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7750this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7751symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7752
7a2de473
HPN
7753Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7754@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7755The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7756of a section.
36f63dca
NC
7757
7758Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7759are left out from an mmo file.
7760
7761@ifclear GENERIC
7762@lowersections
7763@end ifclear
7764@end ifset
7765
7766@ifset MSP430
7767@ifclear GENERIC
7768@raisesections
7769@end ifclear
7770
7771@node MSP430
7772@section @code{ld} and MSP430
7773For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7774will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7775just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7776
7777@cindex MSP430 extra sections
7778The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7779
7780@table @code
7781@item @samp{.vectors}
7782Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7783
7784@item @samp{.bootloader}
7785Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7786in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7787
7788@item @samp{.infomem}
7789Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7790this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7791
c0065db7 7792@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
36f63dca
NC
7793This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7794in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7795
7796@item @samp{.noinit}
7797Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7798
c0065db7 7799The last two sections are used by gcc.
36f63dca
NC
7800@end table
7801
7ef3addb
JL
7802@table @option
7803@cindex MSP430 Options
7804@kindex --code-region
7805@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7806This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7807argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7808using this option.
7809
7810@kindex --data-region
7811@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7812This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7813[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7814for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7815
7816@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7817@item --disable-sec-transformation
7818Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7819and @code{--data-region} options.
7820This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7821wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7822not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7823@end table
7824
36f63dca
NC
7825@ifclear GENERIC
7826@lowersections
7827@end ifclear
7828@end ifset
7829
35c08157
KLC
7830@ifset NDS32
7831@ifclear GENERIC
7832@raisesections
7833@end ifclear
7834
7835@node NDS32
7836@section @code{ld} and NDS32
7837@kindex relaxing on NDS32
7838For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7839relaxes objects according to these options.
7840
7841@table @code
7842@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7843Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7844
7845@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7846Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7847
7848@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7849Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7850
7851@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7852Export the EX9 table after linking.
7853
7854@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7855Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7856
7857@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7858Update the existing EX9 table.
7859
7860@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7861Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7862
7863@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7864Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7865
7866@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7867Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7868
7869@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7870Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7871@end table
7872
7873@ifclear GENERIC
7874@lowersections
7875@end ifclear
7876@end ifset
7877
78058a5e
SL
7878@ifset NIOSII
7879@ifclear GENERIC
7880@raisesections
7881@end ifclear
7882
7883@node Nios II
7884@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7885@cindex Nios II call relaxation
7886@kindex --relax on Nios II
7887
7888Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7889transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7890which may result in @command{ld} giving
7891@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7892The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7893trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7894outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7895trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7896be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7897larger than 256MB.
7898
7899The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7900is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7901@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7902locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7903source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7904register as a temporary.
7905
7906Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7907relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7908option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7909
7910@ifclear GENERIC
7911@lowersections
7912@end ifclear
7913@end ifset
7914
2a60a7a8
AM
7915@ifset POWERPC
7916@ifclear GENERIC
7917@raisesections
7918@end ifclear
7919
7920@node PowerPC ELF32
7921@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7922@cindex PowerPC long branches
7923@kindex --relax on PowerPC
7924Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7925displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7926@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7927@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7928the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7929section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
c8a1f254
NS
7930section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7931@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7932both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7933considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
2a60a7a8
AM
7934
7935@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
7936@table @option
7937@cindex PowerPC PLT
7938@kindex --bss-plt
7939@item --bss-plt
7940Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
7941generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
7942the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
7943writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
7944@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
7945PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
7946compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
7947BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
7948
016687f8
AM
7949@kindex --secure-plt
7950@item --secure-plt
7951@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
7952@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
7953when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
7954layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
7955style BSS PLT.
7956
2a60a7a8
AM
7957@cindex PowerPC GOT
7958@kindex --sdata-got
7959@item --sdata-got
7960The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
7961sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
7962@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
7963section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
7964@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
7965@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
7966@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
7967@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
7968PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
7969pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
7970GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
7971really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
7972
7973@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
7974@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7975@item --emit-stub-syms
7976This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7977symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7978
7979@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
7980@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7981@item --no-tls-optimize
7982PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7983sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7984disable the optimization.
7985@end table
7986
7987@ifclear GENERIC
7988@lowersections
7989@end ifclear
7990@end ifset
7991
7992@ifset POWERPC64
7993@ifclear GENERIC
7994@raisesections
7995@end ifclear
7996
7997@node PowerPC64 ELF64
7998@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7999
8000@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
8001@table @option
8002@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
8003@kindex --stub-group-size
8004@item --stub-group-size
8005Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
8006by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
8007@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
8008sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
8009a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
8010the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
8011conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
8012prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
8013A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
8014branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
8015@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
8016@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
8017detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
8018positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
8019
8020Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
8021single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
8022create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
8023large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
8024
8025@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
8026@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8027@item --emit-stub-syms
8028This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8029symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8030
8031@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
8032@kindex --dotsyms
8033@kindex --no-dotsyms
95421fb9
AM
8034@item --dotsyms
8035@itemx --no-dotsyms
2a60a7a8
AM
8036These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
8037in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
8038function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
8039code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
8040properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
8041to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
8042@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
8043dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
8044feature.
8045
7ae4ea7d
AM
8046@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
8047@kindex --save-restore-funcs
8048@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
95421fb9
AM
8049@item --save-restore-funcs
8050@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7ae4ea7d
AM
8051These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8052provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8053@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
8054function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8055link.
8056
2a60a7a8
AM
8057@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8058@kindex --no-tls-optimize
8059@item --no-tls-optimize
8060PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8061sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8062disable the optimization.
8063
7c9cf415
AM
8064@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8065@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8066@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa
AM
8067@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8068@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
95421fb9
AM
8069@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8070@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa 8071These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7c9cf415
AM
8072stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8073an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8074@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
9e7028aa
AM
8075stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8076generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8077__tls_get_addr_opt.
8078Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8079much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8080an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8081will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8082@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8083and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8084this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8085Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
5cebc931 8086@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
9e7028aa 8087register saves.
7c9cf415 8088
2a60a7a8
AM
8089@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8090@kindex --no-opd-optimize
8091@item --no-opd-optimize
8092PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8093corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
e7fc76dd 8094the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
2a60a7a8
AM
8095Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8096
8097@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8098@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8099@item --non-overlapping-opd
8100Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8101@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8102the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8103entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8104
8105@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8106@kindex --no-toc-optimize
8107@item --no-toc-optimize
8108PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8109entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8110reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8111marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8112marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8113relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8114unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8115reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8116discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8117reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8118code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8119optimization.
8120
d882c988
AM
8121@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8122@kindex --no-inline-optimize
8123@item --no-inline-optimize
8124PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8125marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8126@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8127a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8128locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8129disables that optimization.
8130
2a60a7a8
AM
8131@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8132@kindex --no-multi-toc
8133@item --no-multi-toc
794e51c0
AM
8134If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8135@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8136where TOC
2a60a7a8
AM
8137entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8138total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8139grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8140TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8141calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8142help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
814364K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8144Use this option to turn off this feature.
794e51c0
AM
8145
8146@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8147@kindex --no-toc-sort
8148@item --no-toc-sort
8149By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8150happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8151placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8152with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8153referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8154@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8155results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8156off this feature.
8157
8158@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8159@kindex --plt-align
8160@kindex --no-plt-align
8161@item --plt-align
8162@itemx --no-plt-align
8163Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
2420fff6
AM
8164aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8165boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8166specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8167specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8168if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8169PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
794e51c0
AM
8170
8171@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8172@kindex --plt-static-chain
8173@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8174@item --plt-static-chain
8175@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8176Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8177chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8178chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8179
8180@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8181@kindex --plt-thread-safe
8182@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8183@item --plt-thread-safe
1be5d8d3 8184@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
794e51c0
AM
8185With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8186lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8187another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8188order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8189memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8190barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8191looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8192seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8193default behaviour.
8b5f1ed8
AM
8194
8195@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8196@kindex --plt-localentry
8197@kindex --no-plt-localentry
8198@item --plt-localentry
8199@itemx --no-localentry
8200ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8201ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8202(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8203Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8204or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8205functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8206in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
d44c746a
AM
8207interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8208including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8209to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8210complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8211care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
d882c988
AM
8212
8213@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8214@kindex --power10-stubs
8215@kindex --no-power10-stubs
8216@item --power10-stubs
8217@itemx --no-power10-stubs
8218When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8219relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
e10a07b3
AM
8220linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8221for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8222power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
d882c988
AM
8223power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8224allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
e10a07b3
AM
8225@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8226auto mode.
2a60a7a8
AM
8227@end table
8228
8229@ifclear GENERIC
8230@lowersections
8231@end ifclear
8232@end ifset
8233
b4cbbe8f
AK
8234@ifset S/390
8235@ifclear GENERIC
8236@raisesections
8237@end ifclear
8238
8239@node S/390 ELF
8240@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8241
8242@cindex S/390 ELF options
8243@table @option
8244
8245@cindex S/390
8246@kindex --s390-pgste
8247@item --s390-pgste
8248This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8249segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8250binaries marked that way.
8251@end table
8252
8253@ifclear GENERIC
8254@lowersections
8255@end ifclear
8256@end ifset
8257
49fa1e15
AM
8258@ifset SPU
8259@ifclear GENERIC
8260@raisesections
8261@end ifclear
8262
8263@node SPU ELF
8264@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8265
8266@cindex SPU ELF options
8267@table @option
8268
8269@cindex SPU plugins
8270@kindex --plugin
8271@item --plugin
8272This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8273
8274@cindex SPU overlays
8275@kindex --no-overlays
8276@item --no-overlays
8277Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8278regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8279@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8280turns off all this special overlay handling.
8281
8282@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8283@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8284@item --emit-stub-syms
8285This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8286symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8287
8288@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8289@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8290@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8291This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8292function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8293on calls to non-overlay regions.
8294
8295@cindex SPU local store size
8296@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8297@item --local-store=lo:hi
8298@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8299the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8300range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8301
c0065db7 8302@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8303@kindex --stack-analysis
8304@item --stack-analysis
8305SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8306unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8307under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8308@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8309@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8310determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8311for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8312for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8313for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8314find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8315and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8316under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8317dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8318is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8319and calls will be given.
8320
c0065db7 8321@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8322@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8323@item --emit-stack-syms
8324This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8325in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8326These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8327functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8328functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8329such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8330The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
c0065db7 8331@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
49fa1e15
AM
8332@end table
8333
8334@ifclear GENERIC
8335@lowersections
8336@end ifclear
8337@end ifset
8338
36f63dca
NC
8339@ifset TICOFF
8340@ifclear GENERIC
8341@raisesections
8342@end ifclear
8343
8344@node TI COFF
8345@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8346@cindex TI COFF versions
8347@kindex --format=@var{version}
8348The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8349TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8350also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8351format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8352header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8353
8354@ifclear GENERIC
8355@lowersections
8356@end ifclear
8357@end ifset
8358
2ca22b03
NC
8359@ifset WIN32
8360@ifclear GENERIC
8361@raisesections
8362@end ifclear
8363
8364@node WIN32
8365@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8366
c0065db7 8367This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
a05a5b64
TP
8368See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8369command-line options mentioned here.
2ca22b03
NC
8370
8371@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8372@cindex import libraries
8373@item import libraries
69da35b5 8374The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
2ca22b03 8375libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
69da35b5
NC
8376regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8377archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
2ca22b03 8378support for creating such libraries provided with the
a05a5b64 8379@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
2ca22b03 8380
c0065db7
RM
8381@item exporting DLL symbols
8382@cindex exporting DLL symbols
dc8465bf
NC
8383The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8384
8385@table @emph
8386@item using auto-export functionality
8387@cindex using auto-export functionality
8388By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
a05a5b64 8389which is controlled by the following command-line options:
dc8465bf 8390
0a5d968e
NC
8391@itemize
8392@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8393@item --exclude-symbols
8394@item --exclude-libs
e1c37eb5 8395@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
09e2aba4 8396@item --version-script
0a5d968e
NC
8397@end itemize
8398
09e2aba4
DK
8399When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8400(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8401symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8402often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8403private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
9d5777a3 8404options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
09e2aba4
DK
8405exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8406final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8407
8408If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
0a5d968e
NC
8409command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8410if either of the following are true:
8411
8412@itemize
8413@item A DEF file is used.
8414@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8415@end itemize
dc8465bf 8416
c0065db7
RM
8417@item using a DEF file
8418@cindex using a DEF file
dc8465bf
NC
8419Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8420an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8421exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8422name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
0a5d968e 8423command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
dc8465bf
NC
8424
8425@example
8426gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8427@end example
8428
0a5d968e
NC
8429Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8430@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8431
dc8465bf
NC
8432Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8433
8434@example
4b5bd4e7 8435LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
dc8465bf
NC
8436
8437EXPORTS
8438foo
8439bar
8440_bar = bar
4b5bd4e7
DS
8441another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8442var1 DATA
7fcab871
KT
8443doo = foo == foo2
8444eoo DATA == var1
c0065db7 8445@end example
dc8465bf 8446
7fcab871 8447This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
4b5bd4e7
DS
8448symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8449alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8450by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8451@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
7fcab871
KT
8452@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8453export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8454in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8455symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
4b5bd4e7 8456
6b31ad16
DS
8457The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8458name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8459the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8460
b45619c0
NC
8461When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8462library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
6b31ad16 8463@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
c0065db7 8464executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
6b31ad16
DS
8465
8466With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8467specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
c0065db7 8468non-default base address for the image.
6b31ad16
DS
8469
8470If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
a2877985
DS
8471or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8472filename specified on the command line.
6b31ad16 8473
4b5bd4e7
DS
8474The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8475
8476@example
8477EXPORTS
8478 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8479 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
7fcab871 8480 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
c0065db7 8481@end example
4b5bd4e7
DS
8482
8483Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8484@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8485@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8486@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8487Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
7fcab871
KT
8488@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8489string in import/export table for the symbol.
4b5bd4e7
DS
8490
8491The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8492
8493@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8494will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8495by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8496linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8497library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8498
8499@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8500The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8501the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8502@code{*_imp__foo}).
8503
8504@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8505well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8506read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8507variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8508the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8509extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8510application will behave unexpectedly.
8511
8512@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8513it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8514symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
de194d85 8515API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
4b5bd4e7 8516the DLL without an import library.
c0065db7 8517
4b5bd4e7
DS
8518See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8519other DEF file statements
dc8465bf
NC
8520
8521@cindex creating a DEF file
8522While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
a05a5b64 8523with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
0a5d968e
NC
8524
8525@item Using decorations
8526@cindex Using decorations
8527Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8528itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8529declared as:
8530
8531@example
8532__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8533__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8534@end example
8535
8536All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8537any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8538this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8539the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8540
8541Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
c0065db7 8542decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
0a5d968e
NC
8543instead:
8544
8545@example
8546__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8547__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8548@end example
8549
c0065db7
RM
8550This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8551when included by the library itself the header must declare the
0a5d968e
NC
8552variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8553code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
c0065db7 8554of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
0a5d968e
NC
8555omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8556@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
b45619c0 8557information.
c0065db7 8558@end table
dc8465bf 8559
2ca22b03
NC
8560@cindex automatic data imports
8561@item automatic data imports
8562The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
69da35b5 8563by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
2ca22b03 8564compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
c0065db7 8565issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
69da35b5 8566code to these platforms, especially for large
2ca22b03 8567c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
c0065db7 8568initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
b45619c0 8569decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
c0065db7 8570platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
69da35b5
NC
8571command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8572The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8573suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8574trigger the feature's use.
8575
c0065db7 8576auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
69da35b5
NC
8577additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8578
c0065db7 8579"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
69da35b5
NC
8580documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8581
c0065db7
RM
8582The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8583occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8584One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
69da35b5
NC
8585below.
8586
8587@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
c0065db7
RM
8588For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8589object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8590offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8591field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8592in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
69da35b5 8593without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
c0065db7 8594The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
69da35b5
NC
8595references.
8596
c0065db7
RM
8597The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8598be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8599themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8600runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8601compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8602support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
69da35b5
NC
8603run without error on an older system.
8604
c0065db7
RM
8605@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8606enabled as needed.
2ca22b03
NC
8607
8608@cindex direct linking to a dll
8609@item direct linking to a dll
8610The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8611including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
69da35b5 8612libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
b45619c0 8613traditional import library method, especially when linking large
c0065db7
RM
8614libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8615function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8616though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
69da35b5 8617storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
c0065db7 8618tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
69da35b5
NC
8619large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8620
c0065db7 8621Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
69da35b5 8622@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
c0065db7 8623of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
69da35b5
NC
8624perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8625select the dll instead of an import library.
8626
2ca22b03 8627
69da35b5
NC
8628For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8629to find, in the first directory of its search path,
2ca22b03
NC
8630
8631@example
45e948fe
NC
8632libxxx.dll.a
8633xxx.dll.a
8634libxxx.a
8635xxx.lib
f6c4d4b1 8636libxxx.lib
69da35b5 8637cygxxx.dll (*)
45e948fe
NC
8638libxxx.dll
8639xxx.dll
2ca22b03
NC
8640@end example
8641
69da35b5
NC
8642before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8643
c0065db7
RM
8644(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8645where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8646@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8647file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
69da35b5
NC
8648@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8649
c0065db7
RM
8650Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8651@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
69da35b5
NC
8652was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8653various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8654could coexist on the same machine.
8655
2ca22b03
NC
8656The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8657applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
69da35b5 8658libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
2ca22b03
NC
8659
8660@example
8661bin/
8662 cygxxx.dll
8663lib/
8664 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
c0065db7 8665 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
2ca22b03
NC
8666@end example
8667
c0065db7
RM
8668Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8669done two ways:
2ca22b03
NC
8670
86711. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8672@example
8673gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8674@end example
2ca22b03 8675
69da35b5
NC
8676However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8677(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8678@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8679not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8680
2ca22b03
NC
86812. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8682directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8683should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8684making the app/dll.
8685
8686@example
8687ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
c0065db7 8688@end example
2ca22b03
NC
8689
8690Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8691
8692@example
8693gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8694@end example
69da35b5
NC
8695
8696This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8697perfectly legal
8698
8699@example
8700bin/
8701 cygxxx-5.dll
8702lib/
c0065db7 8703 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
69da35b5
NC
8704@end example
8705
dc8465bf 8706Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
69da35b5
NC
8707even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8708@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8709
8710Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
45e948fe 8711wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
69da35b5
NC
8712
87131. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8714work with auto-imported data.
8715
dc8465bf
NC
87162. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8717import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8718symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8719for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8720possible to do this without an import lib.
69da35b5 8721
45e948fe
NC
87223. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8723critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8724in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8725stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8726
69da35b5 8727So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
c0065db7
RM
8728true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8729a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8730binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
69da35b5
NC
8731massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8732requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8733will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
dc8465bf 8734
c0065db7 8735@item symbol aliasing
dc8465bf 8736@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8737@item adding additional names
8738Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
dc8465bf
NC
8739A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8740exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8741when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
c0065db7 8742import library. Consider the following DEF file:
dc8465bf 8743
c0065db7 8744@example
dc8465bf
NC
8745LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8746
8747EXPORTS
c0065db7 8748foo
dc8465bf 8749_foo = foo
c0065db7 8750@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8751
8752The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8753
8754Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8755source code using the "weak" attribute:
8756
c0065db7
RM
8757@example
8758void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
dc8465bf 8759void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
c0065db7 8760@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8761
8762See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8763symbols.
8764
8765@item renaming symbols
8766Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
c0065db7 8767kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
dc8465bf
NC
8768@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8769DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
c0065db7 8770created). In the following example:
dc8465bf 8771
c0065db7 8772@example
dc8465bf
NC
8773LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8774
8775EXPORTS
8776_foo = foo
c0065db7 8777@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8778
8779The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8780@samp{_foo}.
c0065db7 8781@end table
dc8465bf 8782
0a5d968e 8783Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
a05a5b64 8784unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
0a5d968e 8785If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
c0065db7
RM
8786@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8787that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8788@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8789renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8790to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8791the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8792In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
0a5d968e 8793which is probably not what you wanted.
c87db184
CF
8794
8795@cindex weak externals
8796@item weak externals
8797The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8798weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8799defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8800are three variants of weak externals:
8801@itemize
8802@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8803called lazy externals.
8804@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8805This form is not presently implemented.
8806@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8807implemented.
8808@end itemize
8809As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8810are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8811uses a default value.
c1711530
DK
8812
8813@cindex aligned common symbols
8814@item aligned common symbols
8815As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8816desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8817the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8818carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8819by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8820tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8821but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8822warnings about unknown linker directives.
5063daf7 8823
2ca22b03
NC
8824@end table
8825
8826@ifclear GENERIC
8827@lowersections
8828@end ifclear
8829@end ifset
8830
e0001a05
NC
8831@ifset XTENSA
8832@ifclear GENERIC
8833@raisesections
8834@end ifclear
8835
8836@node Xtensa
8837@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8838
8839@cindex Xtensa processors
8840The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8841@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8842specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8843keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8844example, with the command:
8845
8846@smallexample
8847SECTIONS
8848@{
8849 .text : @{
8850 *(.literal .text)
8851 @}
8852@}
8853@end smallexample
8854
8855@noindent
8856@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8857and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8858literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8859interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8860group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8861files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8862and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
e0001a05 8863
43cd72b9 8864@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
e0001a05 8865@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
43cd72b9
BW
8866Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8867provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8868is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8869literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8870will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8871location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8872the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8873unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8874@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8875range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8876
8877For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8878to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8879instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8880instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8881instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8882@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8883hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8884By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8885switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8886density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8887instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8888performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8889linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8890a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8891
8892The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8893control the linker:
8894
8895@cindex Xtensa options
8896@table @option
43cd72b9
BW
8897@item --size-opt
8898When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8899more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8900no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8901alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8902preserve the correctness of the code.
7a77f1ac
MF
8903
8904@item --abi-windowed
8905@itemx --abi-call0
8906Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8907PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8908because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8909conventions.
8910Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8911of the first input object.
8912A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8913or the chosen output object ABI.
43cd72b9 8914@end table
e0001a05
NC
8915
8916@ifclear GENERIC
8917@lowersections
8918@end ifclear
8919@end ifset
8920
252b5132
RH
8921@ifclear SingleFormat
8922@node BFD
8923@chapter BFD
8924
8925@cindex back end
8926@cindex object file management
8927@cindex object formats available
8928@kindex objdump -i
8929The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8930These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8931object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8932format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8933it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8934associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8935object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
8936(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
8937list all the formats available for your configuration.
8938
8939@cindex BFD requirements
8940@cindex requirements for BFD
8941As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
8942several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
8943BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
8944formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
8945been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
8946BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
8947may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
8948
8949One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
8950mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
8951useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
8952conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
8953
8954@menu
8955* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
8956@end menu
8957
8958@node BFD outline
36f63dca 8959@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
252b5132
RH
8960@cindex opening object files
8961@include bfdsumm.texi
8962@end ifclear
8963
8964@node Reporting Bugs
8965@chapter Reporting Bugs
ff5dcc92
SC
8966@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
8967@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
252b5132 8968
ff5dcc92 8969Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
252b5132
RH
8970
8971Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
8972it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
ff5dcc92 8973to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
252b5132 8974work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
ff5dcc92 8975@command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8976
8977In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
8978information that enables us to fix the bug.
8979
8980@menu
8981* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
8982* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
8983@end menu
8984
8985@node Bug Criteria
36f63dca 8986@section Have You Found a Bug?
252b5132
RH
8987@cindex bug criteria
8988
8989If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
8990
8991@itemize @bullet
8992@cindex fatal signal
8993@cindex linker crash
8994@cindex crash of linker
8995@item
8996If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
ff5dcc92 8997@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
252b5132
RH
8998
8999@cindex error on valid input
9000@item
ff5dcc92 9001If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
252b5132
RH
9002
9003@cindex invalid input
9004@item
ff5dcc92 9005If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
252b5132
RH
9006may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
9007object files are correct.
9008
9009@item
9010If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
ff5dcc92 9011improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
252b5132
RH
9012@end itemize
9013
9014@node Bug Reporting
36f63dca 9015@section How to Report Bugs
252b5132 9016@cindex bug reports
ff5dcc92 9017@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
252b5132
RH
9018
9019A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
ff5dcc92 9020products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
252b5132
RH
9021recommend you contact that organization first.
9022
9023You can find contact information for many support companies and
9024individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
9025distribution.
9026
ad22bfe8 9027@ifset BUGURL
ff5dcc92 9028Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
ad22bfe8
JM
9029@value{BUGURL}.
9030@end ifset
252b5132
RH
9031
9032The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
9033@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
9034fact or leave it out, state it!
9035
9036Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
9037problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
b553b183
NC
9038assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
9039matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
9040the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
9041location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
9042were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
9043into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
9044specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
c0065db7 9045and the most helpful.
b553b183
NC
9046
9047Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9048the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
9049on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
252b5132
RH
9050
9051Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36f63dca
NC
9052bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
9053respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9054You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
252b5132
RH
9055
9056To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9057
9058@itemize @bullet
9059@item
ff5dcc92 9060The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
252b5132
RH
9061the @samp{--version} argument.
9062
9063Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
ff5dcc92 9064the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
9065
9066@item
ff5dcc92 9067Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
252b5132
RH
9068patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9069
9070@item
9071The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9072version number.
9073
9074@item
ff5dcc92 9075What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
252b5132
RH
9076``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9077
9078@item
9079The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9080observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9081list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9082sufficient.
9083
9084If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9085and then we might not encounter the bug.
9086
9087@item
9088A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
b553b183
NC
9089bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9090provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9091bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9092state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9093requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9094we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9095attachments are best.
252b5132
RH
9096
9097If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9098@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9099object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9100@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9101how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9102
9103@item
9104A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9105incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9106
ff5dcc92 9107Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
252b5132
RH
9108will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9109not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9110a chance to make a mistake.
9111
9112Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9113say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
b45619c0 9114copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
252b5132
RH
9115C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9116and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9117fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9118you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9119any conclusion from our observations.
9120
9121@item
ff5dcc92 9122If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
252b5132
RH
9123diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9124@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
ff5dcc92 9125If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
252b5132
RH
9126context, not by line number.
9127
9128The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9129sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9130@end itemize
9131
9132Here are some things that are not necessary:
9133
9134@itemize @bullet
9135@item
9136A description of the envelope of the bug.
9137
9138Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9139which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9140changes will not affect it.
9141
9142This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9143will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9144with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9145We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9146
9147Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9148of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9149output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9150less time, and so on.
9151
9152However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9153report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9154
9155@item
9156A patch for the bug.
9157
9158A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9159the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9160a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9161to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9162
ff5dcc92 9163Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
252b5132
RH
9164construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9165through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9166able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9167fixed.
9168
9169And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9170patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9171help us to understand.
9172
9173@item
9174A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9175
9176Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9177things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9178@end itemize
9179
9180@node MRI
9181@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9182@cindex MRI compatibility
ff5dcc92
SC
9183To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9184linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
252b5132
RH
9185alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9186described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9187simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
ff5dcc92 9188@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
252b5132
RH
9189linker commands; these commands are described here.
9190
9191In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9192file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9193features to make use of them.
9194
9195You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9196@samp{-c} command-line option.
9197
9198Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9199command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9200blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
ff5dcc92 9201MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9202issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9203
9204Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9205
9206You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9207lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9208The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9209
9210@table @code
9211@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9212@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9213@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9214Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
252b5132
RH
9215the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9216@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9217your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9218script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9219commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9220input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9221@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9222
9223@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9224@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9225Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9226in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9227
9228@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9229
9230@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9231@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9232Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9233@var{expression} should be a power of two.
9234
9235@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9236@item BASE @var{expression}
9237Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9238absolute addresses) in the output file.
9239
9240@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9241@item CHIP @var{expression}
9242@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9243This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9244
9245@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9246@item END
9247This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9248
9249@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9250@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9251Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
dc12032b 9252language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
252b5132
RH
9253
9254@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9255@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9256Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
ff5dcc92 9257@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
252b5132
RH
9258
9259The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9260same line, with no change in its effect.
9261
9262@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9263@item LOAD @var{filename}
9264@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9265Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
ff5dcc92 9266same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9267command line.
9268
9269@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9270@item NAME @var{output-name}
ff5dcc92 9271@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
252b5132
RH
9272MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9273option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9274
9275@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9276@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9277@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9278Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
252b5132
RH
9279order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9280script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9281sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9282file, in the order specified.
9283
9284@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9285@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9286@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9287@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9288Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9289@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9290
9291@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9292@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9293@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9294@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9295You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9296specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9297If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9298@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9299@end table
9300
793c5807
NC
9301@node GNU Free Documentation License
9302@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36f63dca 9303@include fdl.texi
704c465c 9304
370b66a1
CD
9305@node LD Index
9306@unnumbered LD Index
252b5132
RH
9307
9308@printindex cp
9309
9310@tex
7ca01ed9 9311% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
252b5132
RH
9312% meantime:
9313\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9314\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9315\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9316\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9317\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9318\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9319\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9320\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9321\page\colophon
7ca01ed9 9322% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
252b5132
RH
9323@end tex
9324
252b5132 9325@bye